drivers/am335xgpio: Add AM335x driver for bitbang support on BeagleBones
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{am335xgpio}
588 @* A Texas Instruments AM335x-based board (e.g. BeagleBone Black) using the GPIO pins of the expansion headers.
589
590 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
591 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
592 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
593
594 @item @b{vdebug}
595 @* A driver for Cadence virtual Debug Interface to emulated or simulated targets.
596 It implements a client connecting to the vdebug server, which in turn communicates
597 with the emulated or simulated RTL model through a transactor. The current version
598 supports only JTAG as a transport, but other virtual transports, like DAP are planned.
599
600 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
601 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
602 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
603 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
604 emulation model of target hardware.
605
606 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
607 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
608
609 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
610 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
611
612 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
613 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
614 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
615
616 @end itemize
617
618 @node About Jim-Tcl
619 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
620 @cindex Jim-Tcl
621 @cindex tcl
622
623 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
624 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
625 command interpreter.
626
627 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
628 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
629 much of anything about Tcl.
630 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
631
632 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
633 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
634 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
635 OpenOCD mailing list.
636
637 @itemize @bullet
638 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
639 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
640 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
641 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
642 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
643 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
644
645 @item @b{Missing Features}
646 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
647 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
648 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
649 enabled in OpenOCD.
650
651 @item @b{Scripts}
652 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
653 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
654 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
655
656 @item @b{Commands}
657 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
658 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
659 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
660 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
661
662 @item @b{Historical Note}
663 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
664 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
665 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
666 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
667
668 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
669 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
670 @end itemize
671
672 @node Running
673 @chapter Running
674 @cindex command line options
675 @cindex logfile
676 @cindex directory search
677
678 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
679 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
680 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
681 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
682 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
683 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
684 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
685
686 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
687 tell it how each debug session should work.
688 The @option{--help} option shows:
689 @verbatim
690 bash$ openocd --help
691
692 --help | -h display this help
693 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
694 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
695 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
696 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
697 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
698 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
699 --command | -c run <command>
700 @end verbatim
701
702 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
703 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
704 To specify one or more different
705 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
706
707 @example
708 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
709 @end example
710
711 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
712 @enumerate
713 @item the current directory,
714 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
715 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
716 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
717 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
718 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
719 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
720 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
721 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
722 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
723 @end enumerate
724 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
725
726 @quotation Note
727 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
728 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
729 @end quotation
730
731 @section Simple setup, no customization
732
733 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
734 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
735 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
736 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
737 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
738
739 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
740 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
741 the server with some variation of one of the following:
742
743 @example
744 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
745 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
746 @end example
747
748 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
749 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
750 If all goes well you'll see output something like
751
752 @example
753 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
754 For bug reports, read
755 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
756 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
757 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
758 @end example
759
760 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
761 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
762 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
763
764 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
765
766 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
767 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
768 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
769 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
770 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
771 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
772 ensure that this always succeeds.
773 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
774 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
775 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
776 and then shut down without acting as a server.
777
778 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
779 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
780 those channels.
781
782 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
783 the @option{-d} option.
784
785 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
786 @option{-c} command line switch.
787
788 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
789 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
790 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
791 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
792 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
793 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
794 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
795
796 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
797 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
798
799 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
800 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
801 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
802 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
803
804 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
805 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
806
807 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
808 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
809 and start the OpenOCD server.
810 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
811 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
812 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
813 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
814
815 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
816
817 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
818 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
819 and a USB cable on the other.
820 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
821 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
822
823 @enumerate
824 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
825 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
826 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
827 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
828 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
829 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
830 debugging host.
831
832 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
833 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
834 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
835 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
836 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
837
838 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
839 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
840 with 1.2 Volt boards.
841
842 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
843 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
844 ways to connect the cable.
845 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
846 Be sure it's firmly connected.
847
848 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
849 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
850 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
851 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
852 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
853 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
854 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
855 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
856
857 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
858 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
859 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
860 but are tedious to set up.
861 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
862 adapter signals to the right board pins.
863
864 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
865 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
866 you are using to run OpenOCD.
867 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
868
869 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
870 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
871 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
872 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
873
874 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
875 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
876 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
877
878 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
879 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
880 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
881 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
882
883 @end enumerate
884
885 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
886 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
887 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
888
889 @section Project Directory
890
891 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
892
893 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
894 single directory for your work with a given board.
895 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
896 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
897 files accessed through semihosting,
898 and for code you upload to the target board.
899 It is also the natural place to write files,
900 such as log files and data you download from the board.
901
902 @section Configuration Basics
903
904 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
905 a variety of ways you can mix them.
906 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
907
908 @itemize
909 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
910 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
911 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
912 @end itemize
913
914 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
915 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
916 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
917
918 @example
919 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
920
921 # GDB can also flash my flash!
922 gdb_memory_map enable
923 gdb_flash_program enable
924
925 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
926 @end example
927
928 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
929
930 @example
931 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
932 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
933 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
934 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
935 @end example
936
937 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
938 each supporting a different development task.
939 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
940 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
941
942 @quotation Important
943 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
944 problems with how it treats variables.
945 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
946 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
947 that can be tested in a later script.
948 @end quotation
949
950 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
951 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
952 to simplify your work.
953
954 @section User Config Files
955 @cindex config file, user
956 @cindex user config file
957 @cindex config file, overview
958
959 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
960 in one place.
961 One of the following will match your situation best:
962
963 @itemize
964 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
965 provided by someone else.
966 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
967 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
968 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
969 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
970 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
971 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
972
973 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
974 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
975
976 @enumerate
977 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
978 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
979 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
980 @end enumerate
981
982 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
983 The first is an interface config file.
984 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
985 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
986 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
987 meet your deadline:
988
989 @example
990 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
991 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
992 @end example
993
994 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
995 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
996 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
997 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
998
999 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1000 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1001 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1002 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1003 target and board
1004 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1005 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1006
1007 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1008 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1009 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1010 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1011
1012 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1013 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1014 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1015 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1016 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1017
1018 @quotation Note
1019 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1020 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1021 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1022 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1023 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1024 @end quotation
1025
1026 @item
1027 You may need to write some C code.
1028 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1029 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1030 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1031 a new chip architecture.
1032 @end itemize
1033
1034 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1035 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1036 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1037
1038 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1039 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1040 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1041 @itemize
1042
1043 @item
1044 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1045 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1046 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1047 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1048
1049 @item
1050 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1051 @cindex vector_catch
1052 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1053 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1054 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1055 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1056 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1057 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1058
1059 @item
1060 You might need to override some defaults.
1061 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1062 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1063
1064 @item
1065 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1066 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1067 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1068 @end itemize
1069
1070 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1071
1072 A few project-specific utility
1073 routines may well speed up your work.
1074 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1075
1076 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1077 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1078 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1079 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1080 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1081 may help:
1082
1083 @example
1084 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1085 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1086 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1087 # Leave the CPU halted.
1088 reset init
1089
1090 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1091 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1092
1093 # Start running.
1094 resume 0x20000000
1095 @}
1096 @end example
1097
1098 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1099 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1100 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1101 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1102 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1103
1104 @example
1105 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1106 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1107 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1108 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1109 reset init
1110
1111 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1112 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1113 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1114 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1115 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1116 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1117 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1118
1119 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1120 reset run
1121 @}
1122 @end example
1123
1124 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1125 from NAND.
1126 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1127 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1128 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1129
1130 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1131 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1132
1133 @section Target Software Changes
1134
1135 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1136 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1137 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1138 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1139 handling issues like:
1140
1141 @itemize @bullet
1142
1143 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1144 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1145 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1146 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1147 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1148 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1149 your debug sessions.
1150
1151 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1152 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1153 That might however be your only option.
1154
1155 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1156 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1157 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1158 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1159 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1160 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1161 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1162 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1163 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1164 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1165 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1166 instead of the whole thing.
1167 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1168 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1169
1170 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1171 @cindex ARM semihosting
1172 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1173 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1174 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1175 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1176 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1177 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1178 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1179 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1180 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1181 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1182 NAND or SPI flash.
1183
1184 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1185 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1186 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1187 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1188 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1189
1190 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1191 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1192 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1193 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1194 registers which can be used to change various features including
1195 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1196 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1197 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1198 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1199 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1200
1201 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1202 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1203 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1204 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1205 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1206
1207 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1208 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1209 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1210 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1211 early code execution can be debugged
1212 or firmware can be replaced.
1213
1214 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1215 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1216 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1217 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1218 operations like writing to memory.)
1219
1220 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1221 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1222 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1223 various kinds of message.
1224 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1225
1226 @end itemize
1227
1228 @section Target Hardware Setup
1229
1230 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1231 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1232 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1233 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1234 working with.}
1235
1236 Common issues include:
1237
1238 @itemize @bullet
1239
1240 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1241 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1242 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1243 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1244 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1245 or one from a daughtercard).
1246 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1247 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1248
1249 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1250 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1251 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1252 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1253 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1254 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1255
1256 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1257 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1258 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1259 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1260 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1261
1262
1263 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1264 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1265 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1266 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1267 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1268 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1269 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1270
1271 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1272 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1273 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1274 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1275 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1276
1277 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1278 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1279 used to start booting.
1280
1281 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1282 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1283 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1284 multiple audio codec chips).
1285 This interacts with software
1286 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1287 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1288 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1289 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1290 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1291 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1292 audio or video codecs are used.
1293
1294 @end itemize
1295
1296 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1297 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1298 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1299 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1300 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1301 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1302 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1303 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1304 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1305 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1306
1307
1308 @node Config File Guidelines
1309 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1310
1311 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1312 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1313 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1314 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1315
1316 You should find the following directories under
1317 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1318 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1319 @itemize @bullet
1320 @item @file{interface} ...
1321 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1322 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1323 @item @file{board} ...
1324 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1325 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1326
1327 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1328 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1329 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1330 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1331 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1332 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1333 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1334 a CPU and an FPGA.
1335 @item @file{target} ...
1336 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1337 on a chip
1338 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1339 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1340 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1341 the target config file defines all of them.
1342 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1343 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1344 @end itemize
1345
1346 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1347 file may override features in any of the above files by
1348 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1349 commands specific to their situation.
1350
1351 @section Interface Config Files
1352
1353 The user config file
1354 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1355
1356 @example
1357 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1358 @end example
1359
1360 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1361 in use today with OpenOCD.
1362 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1363 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1364
1365 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1366 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1367 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1368 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1369 and need to provide a driver for it.
1370
1371 @deffn {Command} {find} 'filename'
1372 Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules.
1373 @end deffn
1374
1375 @deffn {Command} {ocd_find} 'filename'
1376 Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules. This
1377 is a low level function used by the @command{find}. Usually you want
1378 to use @command{find}, instead.
1379 @end deffn
1380
1381 @section Board Config Files
1382 @cindex config file, board
1383 @cindex board config file
1384
1385 The user config file
1386 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1387
1388 @example
1389 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1390 @end example
1391
1392 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1393 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1394 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1395
1396 @enumerate
1397 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1398 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1399 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1400 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1401 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1402 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1403 @end enumerate
1404
1405 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1406 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1407 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1408 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1409
1410 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1411 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1412 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1413 configuration works.
1414
1415 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1416
1417 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1418 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1419 convention on how to use certain variables.
1420
1421 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1422 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1423 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1424 used at will within a target configuration file.
1425
1426 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1427 for a board with three chips:
1428
1429 @example
1430 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1431 set CHIPNAME network
1432 set ENDIAN big
1433 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1434 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1435 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1436 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1437
1438 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1439 set CHIPNAME video
1440 set ENDIAN little
1441 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1442 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1443 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1444 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1445
1446 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1447 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1448 unset ENDIAN
1449 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1450 @end example
1451
1452 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1453 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1454 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1455 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1456 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1457 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1458 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1459 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1460
1461 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1462 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1463 naming collisions.
1464
1465 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1466 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1467 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1468 up other clocks and peripherals.
1469
1470 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1471 @cindex variable names
1472
1473 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1474 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1475 one such chip (as shown above).
1476 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1477 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1478 to promote consistency and
1479 so that board files can override target defaults.
1480
1481 Inputs to target config files include:
1482
1483 @itemize @bullet
1484 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1485 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1486 tap identifier dotted names.
1487 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1488 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1489 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1490 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1491 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1492 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1493 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1494 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1495 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1496 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1497 @end itemize
1498
1499 Outputs from target config files include:
1500
1501 @itemize @bullet
1502 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1503 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1504 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1505 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1506 specific to that board and that target.
1507 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1508 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1509 @end itemize
1510
1511 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1512 @cindex event, reset-init
1513 @cindex reset-init handler
1514
1515 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1516 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1517 fully set up yet.
1518 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1519 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1520 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1521 handler is one of the most important.
1522
1523 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1524 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1525 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1526 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1527 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1528
1529 @quotation Note
1530 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1531 are included here.
1532 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1533 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1534 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1535 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1536 @end quotation
1537
1538 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1539 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1540 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1541 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1542 those as parameters.
1543 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1544 and disabling the watchdog.
1545 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1546 the next developer doing such work.
1547 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1548
1549 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1550 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1551 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1552 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1553
1554 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1555
1556 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1557 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1558 a low JTAG clock rate.
1559 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1560 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1561 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1562 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1563 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1564 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1565 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1566
1567 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1568 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1569 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1570 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1571 which might be less than that.
1572
1573 @quotation Warning
1574 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1575 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1576 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1577 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1578 @end quotation
1579
1580 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1581 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1582 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1583 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1584 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1585 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1586
1587 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1588 @subsection The init_board procedure
1589 @cindex init_board procedure
1590
1591 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1592 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1593 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1594 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1595 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1596 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1597 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1598 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1599 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1600 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1601 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1602 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1603
1604 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1605 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1606
1607 @example
1608 ### board_file.cfg ###
1609
1610 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1611 source [find target/target.cfg]
1612
1613 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1614 # enables fast on-board clock source
1615 # configures the chip to use it
1616 @}
1617
1618 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1619 proc init_board @{@} @{
1620 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1621
1622 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1623 adapter speed 100
1624 @}
1625
1626 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1627 enable_fast_clock
1628 adapter speed 10000
1629 @}
1630 @}
1631 @end example
1632
1633 @section Target Config Files
1634 @cindex config file, target
1635 @cindex target config file
1636
1637 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1638 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1639 more target config files like this:
1640
1641 @example
1642 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1643 @end example
1644
1645 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1646 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1647 In summary the target files should contain
1648
1649 @enumerate
1650 @item Set defaults
1651 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1652 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1653 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1654 @item On-Chip flash
1655 @end enumerate
1656
1657 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1658 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1659 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1660
1661 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1662 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1663 can talk to the chip.
1664 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1665 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1666 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1667 and other processing engines.
1668
1669 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1670
1671 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1672 letting board config files express environment-specific
1673 differences in how things should be set up.
1674
1675 @example
1676 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1677 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1678 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1679 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1680 @} else @{
1681 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1682 @}
1683
1684 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1685 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1686 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1687 @} else @{
1688 set _ENDIAN little
1689 @}
1690
1691 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1692 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1693 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1694 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1695 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1696 @} else @{
1697 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1698 @}
1699 @end example
1700 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1701
1702 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1703 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1704 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1705
1706 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1707 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1708 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1709
1710 @example
1711 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1712 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1713 @end example
1714
1715 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1716 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1717 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1718 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1719 for taps.
1720
1721 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1722 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1723 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1724 looks (in part) like this:
1725
1726 @example
1727 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1728 @end example
1729
1730 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1731 to source such a config file twice, with different
1732 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1733 it adds a different TAP each time.
1734
1735 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1736 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1737 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1738 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1739
1740 @example
1741 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1742 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1743 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1744 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1745 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1746 @end example
1747
1748 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1749 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1750
1751 @itemize
1752 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1753 plus a JRC to enable them
1754 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1755 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1756 is not currently used)
1757 @end itemize
1758
1759 @subsection Add CPU targets
1760
1761 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1762 GDB and other commands can use it.
1763 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1764 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1765 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1766 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1767
1768 @example
1769 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1770 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1771 @end example
1772
1773 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1774 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1775 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1776 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1777 a work area if you can.
1778 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1779
1780 @example
1781 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1782 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1783 @end example
1784
1785 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1786 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1787 @cindex SMP
1788 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1789
1790 @example
1791 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1792 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1793 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1794 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1795 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1796 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1797 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1798 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1799 @end example
1800 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1801 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1802 @itemize @bullet
1803 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1804 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1805 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1806 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1807 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1808 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1809 @end itemize
1810
1811 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1812 command have been implemented.
1813 @itemize @bullet
1814 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1815 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1816 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1817 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1818 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1819 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1820 following example.
1821 @end itemize
1822
1823 @example
1824 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1825 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1826 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1827 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1828 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1829 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1830 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1831 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1832 > resume
1833 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1834 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1835 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1836 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1837 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1838 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1839 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1840 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1841 @end example
1842
1843
1844 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1845
1846 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1847 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1848 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1849
1850 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1851 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1852 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1853 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1854 both signals.
1855
1856 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1857 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1858 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1859 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1860 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1861 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1862 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1863 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1864 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1865 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1866 not available.)
1867
1868 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1869 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1870 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1871 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1872 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1873 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1874 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1875 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1876
1877 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1878 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1879 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1880 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1881 slower clock than they will use later.
1882 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1883 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1884 than they will use later.
1885 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1886
1887 @quotation Important
1888 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1889 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1890 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1891 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1892 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1893 @end quotation
1894
1895 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1896 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1897 @cindex init_targets procedure
1898
1899 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1900 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1901 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1902 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1903 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1904 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1905 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1906 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1907 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1908
1909 @example
1910 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1911
1912 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1913 # basic initialization procedure ...
1914 @}
1915
1916 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1917 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1918 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1919 @}
1920
1921 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1922
1923 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1924
1925 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1926 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1927 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1928 @}
1929 @end example
1930
1931 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1932 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1933
1934 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1935
1936 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1937 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1938
1939 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1940 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1941 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1942
1943 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1944 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1945 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1946 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1947 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1948 events already assigned.
1949
1950 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1951
1952 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1953 special high speed download features - enable it.
1954
1955 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1956
1957 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1958 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1959 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1960 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1961 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1962 If you are using an external trace port,
1963 configure it in your board config file.
1964 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1965 configure it in your target config file.
1966
1967 @example
1968 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1969 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1970 @end example
1971
1972 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1973
1974 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1975
1976 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1977 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1978 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1979 the TARGET (chip) file.
1980
1981 Examples:
1982 @itemize @bullet
1983 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1984 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1985 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1986 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1987 @end itemize
1988
1989 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1990 @section Translating Configuration Files
1991 @cindex translation
1992 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1993 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1994 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1995 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1996 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1997 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1998
1999 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
2000 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
2001 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
2002 convert other scripts later on.
2003
2004 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
2005 replace job:
2006
2007 @example
2008 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2009 #
2010 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2011 #
2012 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2013 #
2014 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2015
2016 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2017 global TARGETNAME
2018
2019 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2020
2021 arm mcr 15 [expr @{($regs >> 12) & 0x7@}] \
2022 [expr @{($regs >> 0) & 0xf@}] [expr @{($regs >> 4) & 0xf@}] \
2023 [expr @{($regs >> 8) & 0x7@}] $value
2024 @}
2025 @end example
2026
2027
2028
2029 @node Server Configuration
2030 @chapter Server Configuration
2031 @cindex initialization
2032 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2033 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2034 supported.
2035
2036 @anchor{configurationstage}
2037 @section Configuration Stage
2038 @cindex configuration stage
2039 @cindex config command
2040
2041 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2042 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2043 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2044 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2045 inside startup scripts.
2046
2047 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2048 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2049 which may be issued interactively.
2050 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2051 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2052
2053 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2054 flash banks,
2055 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2056 and other basic setup.
2057 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2058 may access or activate TAPs.
2059 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2060 longer be issued.
2061
2062 @deffn {Command} {command mode} [command_name]
2063 Returns the command modes allowed by a command: 'any', 'config', or
2064 'exec'. If no command is specified, returns the current command
2065 mode. Returns 'unknown' if an unknown command is given. Command can be
2066 multiple tokens. (command valid any time)
2067
2068 In this document, the modes are described as stages, 'config' and
2069 'exec' mode correspond configuration stage and run stage. 'any' means
2070 the command can be executed in either
2071 stages. @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}, and
2072 @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.
2073 @end deffn
2074
2075 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2076 @section Entering the Run Stage
2077
2078 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2079 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2080 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2081 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2082 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2083 You should see no errors at this point.
2084 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2085 commands you used to configure the server.
2086 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2087 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2088 on the scan chain.
2089
2090 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2091 become available.
2092 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2093 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2094 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2095 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2096 entry to the run stage.
2097
2098 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2099 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2100 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2101 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2102 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2103 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2104 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2105
2106 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2107 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2108 configuration files and/or command line options.
2109
2110 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs near the end of your
2111 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2112 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2113 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2114 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2115
2116 @command{init} calls the following internal OpenOCD commands to initialize
2117 corresponding subsystems:
2118 @deffn {Config Command} {target init}
2119 @deffnx {Command} {transport init}
2120 @deffnx {Command} {dap init}
2121 @deffnx {Config Command} {flash init}
2122 @deffnx {Config Command} {nand init}
2123 @deffnx {Config Command} {pld init}
2124 @deffnx {Command} {tpiu init}
2125 @end deffn
2126
2127 At last, @command{init} executes all the commands that are specified in
2128 the TCL list @var{post_init_commands}. The commands are executed in the
2129 same order they occupy in the list. If one of the commands fails, then
2130 the error is propagated and OpenOCD fails too.
2131 @example
2132 lappend post_init_commands @{echo "OpenOCD successfully initialized."@}
2133 lappend post_init_commands @{echo "Have fun with OpenOCD !"@}
2134 @end example
2135 @end deffn
2136
2137 @deffn {Config Command} {noinit}
2138 Prevent OpenOCD from implicit @command{init} call at the end of startup.
2139 Allows issuing configuration commands over telnet or Tcl connection.
2140 When you are done with configuration use @command{init} to enter
2141 the run stage.
2142 @end deffn
2143
2144 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2145 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2146 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2147
2148 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2149 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2150 scan chain.
2151 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2152 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2153
2154 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2155 they return.
2156 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2157 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2158 @end deffn
2159
2160 @anchor{tcpipports}
2161 @section TCP/IP Ports
2162 @cindex TCP port
2163 @cindex server
2164 @cindex port
2165 @cindex security
2166 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2167 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2168 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2169
2170 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2171 access using one or more of these ports.
2172 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2173 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2174 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2175
2176 @anchor{gdb_port}
2177 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2178 @cindex GDB server
2179 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2180 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2181 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2182 the normal use cases.
2183
2184 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2185 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2186 disables the gdb server.
2187
2188 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2189 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2190
2191 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2192 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2193 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2194
2195 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2196 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2197 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2198 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2199 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2200 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2201 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2202 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2203 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2204
2205 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2206 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2207 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2208 @end deffn
2209
2210 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2211 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2212 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2213 output from the Tcl engine.
2214 Intended as a machine interface.
2215 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2216 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2217 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2218 @end deffn
2219
2220 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2221 Specify or query the
2222 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2223 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2224 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2225 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2226 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2230 @section GDB Configuration
2231 @cindex GDB
2232 @cindex GDB configuration
2233 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2234 The ones listed here are static and global.
2235 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2236 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2237
2238 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2239 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2240 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2241 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2242 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2243 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2244 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2245 @end deffn
2246
2247 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2248 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2249 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2250 vFlash packet is received.
2251 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2252 @end deffn
2253
2254 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2255 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2256 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2257 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2258 for flash programming to work.
2259 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2260 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2261 @end deffn
2262
2263 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2264 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2265 by GDB memory read packets.
2266 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2267 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2268 @end deffn
2269
2270 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2271 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2272 packets report errors or not.
2273 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2274 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2275 @end deffn
2276
2277 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2278 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2279 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2280 @end deffn
2281
2282 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2283 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2284
2285 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2286 @end deffn
2287
2288 @anchor{eventpolling}
2289 @section Event Polling
2290
2291 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2292 where significant events can happen at any time.
2293 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2294 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2295 or to GDB.
2296
2297 Examples of such events include:
2298
2299 @itemize
2300 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2301 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2302 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2303 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2304 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2305 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2306 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2307 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2308 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2309 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2310 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2311 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2312 @end itemize
2313
2314 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2315 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2316 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2317 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2318 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2319
2320 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2321 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2322 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2323 to the various active targets.
2324 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2325 which is normally done in the background.
2326
2327 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2328 Poll the current target for its current state.
2329 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2330 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2331 specific information about the current state is printed.
2332 An optional parameter
2333 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2334
2335 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2336 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2337 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2338 @example
2339 > poll
2340 background polling: on
2341 target state: halted
2342 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2343 current mode: Supervisor
2344 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2345 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2346 >
2347 @end example
2348 @end deffn
2349
2350 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2351 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2352 @cindex config file, interface
2353 @cindex interface config file
2354
2355 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2356 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2357 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2358
2359 @quotation Note
2360 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2361 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2362 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2363 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2364 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2365 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2366 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2367 @end quotation
2368
2369 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2370 through commands in an interface configuration
2371 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2372 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2373
2374 @example
2375 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2376 @end example
2377
2378 These commands tell
2379 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2380 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2381
2382 @example
2383 # jlink interface
2384 adapter driver jlink
2385 @end example
2386
2387 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2388
2389
2390 @section Adapter Configuration
2391
2392 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2393 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2394 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2395
2396 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2397 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2398 target.
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2402 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2403 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2404 @end deffn
2405 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2406 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2407 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2408 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2409 the hardware can support.
2410 @end deffn
2411
2412
2413
2414 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2415 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2416 @end deffn
2417
2418 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2419 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2420 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2421 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2422 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2423 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2424 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2425
2426 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2427 @end deffn
2428
2429 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
2430 Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
2431 If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
2432 Only the following adapter drivers use the serial string from this command:
2433 aice (aice_usb), arm-jtag-ew, cmsis_dap, ft232r, ftdi, hla (stlink, ti-icdi), jlink, kitprog, opendus,
2434 openjtag, osbdm, presto, rlink, st-link, usb_blaster (ublast2), usbprog, vsllink, xds110.
2435 @end deffn
2436
2437 @section Interface Drivers
2438
2439 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2440 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2441 available at run time.
2442
2443 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2444 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2445 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2446 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2447
2448 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2449 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2450 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2451 @end deffn
2452
2453 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2454 Displays status of RTCK option.
2455 Optionally sets that option first.
2456 @end deffn
2457 @end deffn
2458
2459 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2460 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2461 This has one driver-specific command:
2462
2463 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2464 Logs some status
2465 @end deffn
2466 @end deffn
2467
2468 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2469 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2470 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2471 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2472 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2473 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2474 @end deffn
2475
2476 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2477 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2478 or v2 (USB bulk).
2479
2480 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2481 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2482 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2483 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2484 @example
2485 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2486 @end example
2487 @end deffn
2488
2489 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2490 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2491
2492 @itemize @minus
2493 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2494 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2495 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2496 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2497 @end itemize
2498 @end deffn
2499
2500 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2501 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2502 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2503 interface string or for user class interface.
2504 @end deffn
2505
2506 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2507 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2508 @end deffn
2509
2510 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap cmd} number number ...
2511 Execute an arbitrary CMSIS-DAP command. Use for adapter testing or for handling
2512 of an adapter vendor specific command from a Tcl script.
2513
2514 Take given numbers as bytes, assemble a CMSIS-DAP protocol command packet
2515 from them and send it to the adapter. The first 4 bytes of the adapter response
2516 are logged.
2517 See @url{https://arm-software.github.io/CMSIS_5/DAP/html/group__DAP__Commands__gr.html}
2518 @end deffn
2519 @end deffn
2520
2521 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2522 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2523 @end deffn
2524
2525 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2526 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2527 @end deffn
2528
2529 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2530 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2531 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2532
2533 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2534 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2535
2536 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2537 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2538
2539 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2540 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2541 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2542 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2543 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2544 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2545
2546 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2547 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2548 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2549 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2550 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2551
2552 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2553 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2554 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2555 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2556
2557 @itemize @minus
2558 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2559 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2560 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2561 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2562 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2563 switching data and direction as necessary
2564 @end itemize
2565
2566 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2567 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2568
2569 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2570 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2571 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2572 @example
2573 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2574 @end example
2575 @end deffn
2576
2577 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2578 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2579 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2580 during device selection.
2581 @end deffn
2582
2583 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2584 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2585 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2586 @end deffn
2587
2588 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2589 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2590 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2591 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2592 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2593 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2594 and initially asserted reset signals.
2595 @end deffn
2596
2597 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2598 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2599 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2600 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2601 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2602 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2603 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2604 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2605 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2606 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2607 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2608
2609 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2610 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2611 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2612 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2613 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2614 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2615
2616 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2617 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2618 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2619 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2620 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2621 are always driven by the FTDI.
2622
2623 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2624 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2625 @var{name}.
2626 @end deffn
2627
2628 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2629 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2630 @itemize @minus
2631 @item @option{0}, drive low
2632 @item @option{1}, drive high
2633 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2634 @end itemize
2635 @end deffn
2636
2637 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2638 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2639 @end deffn
2640
2641 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2642 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2643
2644 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2645 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2646 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2647 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2648 @itemize @minus
2649 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2650 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2651 @end itemize
2652 @end deffn
2653
2654 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2655 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2656
2657 @end deffn
2658
2659 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2660 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2661 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2662 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2663
2664 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2665 @itemize @minus
2666 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2667 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2668 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2669 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2670 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2671 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2672 @end itemize
2673
2674 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2675 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2676 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2677 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2678 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2679 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2680 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2681 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2682
2683 FT232R
2684 @itemize @minus
2685 @item bit 7 - RI
2686 @item bit 6 - DCD
2687 @item bit 5 - DSR
2688 @item bit 4 - DTR
2689 @item bit 3 - CTS
2690 @item bit 2 - RTS
2691 @item bit 1 - RXD
2692 @item bit 0 - TXD
2693 @end itemize
2694
2695 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2696 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2697
2698 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2699 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2700 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2701 @end deffn
2702
2703 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2704 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2705 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2706 @end deffn
2707
2708 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2709 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2710 @end deffn
2711
2712 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2713 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2714 @end deffn
2715
2716 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2717 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2718 @end deffn
2719
2720 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2721 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2722 @end deffn
2723
2724 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2725 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2726 @end deffn
2727
2728 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2729 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2730 @end deffn
2731
2732 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2733 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2734 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2735 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2736 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2737 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2738 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2739 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2740 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2741 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2742 @end deffn
2743
2744 @end deffn
2745
2746 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2747 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2748 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2749 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2750
2751 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2752 processors which are being simulated.
2753
2754 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2755 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2756 sockets instead of TCP.
2757 @end deffn
2758
2759 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2760 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2761 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2762 @end deffn
2763
2764 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2765 something like:
2766
2767 @example
2768 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2769 remote_bitbang port 3335
2770 remote_bitbang host foobar
2771 @end example
2772
2773 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2774 named mysocket:
2775
2776 @example
2777 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2778 remote_bitbang port 0
2779 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2780 @end example
2781 @end deffn
2782
2783 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2784 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2785 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2786 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2787
2788 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2789 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2790 default values are used.
2791 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2792 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2793 @example
2794 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2795 @end example
2796 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2797 @example
2798 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2799 @end example
2800 @end deffn
2801
2802 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2803 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2804 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2805 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2806 target board.
2807
2808 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2809 @example
2810 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2811 reset_config srst_only
2812 @end example
2813 @end deffn
2814
2815 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2816 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2817 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2818 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2819 @end deffn
2820
2821 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2822 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2823 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2824 @end deffn
2825
2826 @end deffn
2827
2828 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2829 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2830 This has one driver-specific command:
2831
2832 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2833 Display either the address of the I/O port
2834 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2835 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2836 This is a write-once setting.
2837 @end deffn
2838 @end deffn
2839
2840 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2841 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2842 transports.
2843
2844 @quotation Compatibility Note
2845 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2846 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2847 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2848 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2849 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2850 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2851 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2852 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2853 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2854 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2855 @end quotation
2856
2857 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2858 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2859 states.
2860 @end deffn
2861 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2862 Display free device internal memory.
2863 @end deffn
2864 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2865 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2866 command version.
2867 @end deffn
2868 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2869 Display the device configuration.
2870 @end deffn
2871 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2872 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2873 power state.
2874 @end deffn
2875 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2876 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2877 @end deffn
2878 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2879 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2880 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2881 IP configuration.
2882 @end deffn
2883 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2884 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2885 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2886 @end deffn
2887 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2888 Reset the current configuration.
2889 @end deffn
2890 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2891 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2892 @end deffn
2893 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
2894 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2895 pairs.
2896
2897 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2898 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2899 @example
2900 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2901 @end example
2902 @end deffn
2903 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
2904 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2905 pairs.
2906
2907 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2908 @example
2909 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2910 77a90000
2911 @end example
2912 @end deffn
2913 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2914 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2915 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2916 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2917 the serial number instead, if possible.
2918
2919 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2920 @end deffn
2921 @end deffn
2922
2923 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2924 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2925 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2926 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2927 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2928 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2929 configuration script.
2930
2931 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2932 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2933 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2934 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2935 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2936
2937 Known limitations:
2938 @itemize @bullet
2939 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2940 and 2.7 MHz.
2941 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2942 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2943 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2944 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2945 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2946 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2947 communications with the target.
2948 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2949 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2950 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2951 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2952 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2953 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2954 @end itemize
2955
2956 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2957 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2958 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2959 @end deffn
2960
2961 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2962 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2963 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2964 target as a side-effect.
2965 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2966 @end deffn
2967
2968 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2969 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2970 version, and target voltage.
2971 @end deffn
2972 @end deffn
2973
2974 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2975 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2976 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2977 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2978 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2979
2980 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
2981 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2982 This is a write-once setting.
2983 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2984
2985 @itemize @minus
2986 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2987 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2988 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2989 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2990 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2991 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2992 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2993 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2994 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2995 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2996 some versions of
2997 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2998 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2999 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
3000 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
3001 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
3002 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
3003 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
3004 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
3005 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
3006 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
3007 @end itemize
3008 @end deffn
3009
3010 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
3011 Display either the address of the I/O port
3012 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
3013 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
3014 This is a write-once setting.
3015
3016 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
3017 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
3018 you may encounter a problem.
3019 @end deffn
3020
3021 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
3022 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
3023 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3024 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
3025 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3026 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3027
3028 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3029 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3030 @quotation Tip
3031 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3032 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3033 @example
3034 > parport toggling_time 1000
3035 > adapter speed 500
3036 @end example
3037 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3038 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3039 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3040 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3041 large set of samples.
3042 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3043 @example
3044 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3045 @end example
3046 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3047 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3048
3049 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3050 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3051 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3052 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3053 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3054 be conservative.
3055 @end quotation
3056 @end deffn
3057
3058 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3059 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3060 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3061 @end deffn
3062
3063 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3064 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3065
3066 @example
3067 adapter driver parport
3068 parport port 0x278
3069 parport cable wiggler
3070 @end example
3071 @end deffn
3072
3073 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3074 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3075 @end deffn
3076
3077 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3078 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3079 @end deffn
3080
3081 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3082 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3083 @end deffn
3084
3085 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3086 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3087
3088 @quotation Note
3089 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3090 which are not currently documented here.
3091 @end quotation
3092 @end deffn
3093
3094 @anchor{hla_interface}
3095 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3096 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3097 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3098 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3099
3100 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3101 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3102 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3103 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3104 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3105 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3106
3107 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3108 Currently Not Supported.
3109 @end deffn
3110
3111 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3112 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3113 @end deffn
3114
3115 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3116 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3117 @end deffn
3118
3119 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3120 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3121 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3122
3123 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3124 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3125 ST-LINK server software module}.
3126 @end deffn
3127
3128 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3129 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3130 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3131 @end deffn
3132 @end deffn
3133
3134 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3135 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3136 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3137 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3138 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3139
3140 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3141 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3142 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3143 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3144
3145 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3146 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3147
3148 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3149 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3150 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3151
3152 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3153 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3154 ST-LINK server software module}.
3155
3156 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3157 @end deffn
3158
3159 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3160 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3161 @end deffn
3162
3163 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3164 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3165 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3166
3167 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3168 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3169 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3170 the target's supply voltage.
3171 @example
3172 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3173 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3174 @end example
3175 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3176 @example
3177 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3178 > set n [expr @{[lindex $a 4] + 256 * [lindex $a 5]@}]
3179 > set d [expr @{[lindex $a 0] + 256 * [lindex $a 1]@}]
3180 > echo [expr @{2 * 1.2 * $n / $d@}]
3181 3.24891518738
3182 @end example
3183 @end deffn
3184 @end deffn
3185
3186 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3187 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3188 @end deffn
3189
3190 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3191 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3192 @end deffn
3193
3194 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3195 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3196 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3197 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3198 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3199
3200 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3201 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3202 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3203 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3204 @end deffn
3205
3206 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3207 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3208 version).
3209 @end deffn
3210 @end deffn
3211
3212 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3213 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3214 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3215 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3216 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3217
3218 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3219
3220 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3221 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3222
3223 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3224 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3225
3226 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3227
3228 @end deffn
3229 @end deffn
3230
3231 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3232 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3233 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3234
3235 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3236 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3237 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3238 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3239 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3240 configuration on exit.
3241
3242 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons.
3243
3244 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3245 pinout.
3246
3247 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3248 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3249 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3250 individually.
3251 @end deffn
3252
3253 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tck_num} @var{tck}
3254 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3255 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3256 @end deffn
3257
3258 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tms_num} @var{tms}
3259 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3260 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3261 @end deffn
3262
3263 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3264 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3265 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3266 @end deffn
3267
3268 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3269 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3270 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3271 @end deffn
3272
3273 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3274 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3275 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3276 @end deffn
3277
3278 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3279 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3280 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3281 @end deffn
3282
3283 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3284 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3285 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3286 @end deffn
3287
3288 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio} @var{dir}
3289 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3290 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin (set=output
3291 mode, clear=input mode). If not specified, this feature is disabled.
3292 @end deffn
3293
3294 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio srst_num} @var{srst}
3295 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3296 @end deffn
3297
3298 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio trst_num} @var{trst}
3299 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3300 @end deffn
3301
3302 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3303 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3304 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3305 @end deffn
3306
3307 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3308 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
3309 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3310 list can be found in the
3311 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3312 @end deffn
3313
3314 @end deffn
3315
3316 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3317 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3318 of the one which is most popular.
3319
3320 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3321
3322 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3323 pinout.
3324
3325 @end deffn
3326
3327
3328 @deffn {Interface Driver} {am335xgpio} The AM335x SoC is present in BeagleBone
3329 Black and BeagleBone Green single-board computers which expose some of the GPIOs
3330 on the two expansion headers.
3331
3332 For maximum performance the driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral
3333 registers directly. The memory mapping requires read and write permission to
3334 kernel memory; if /dev/gpiomem exists it will be used, otherwise /dev/mem will
3335 be used. The driver restores the GPIO state on exit.
3336
3337 All four GPIO ports are available. GPIOs numbered 0 to 31 are mapped to GPIO port
3338 0, GPIO numbers 32 to 63 are mapped to GPIO port 1 and so on.
3339
3340 See @file{interface/beaglebone-swd-native.cfg} for a sample configuration file.
3341
3342 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3343 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3344 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3345 individually.
3346 @end deffn
3347
3348 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio tck_num} @var{tck}
3349 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3350 specified using the configuration command @command{am335xgpio jtag_nums}.
3351 @end deffn
3352
3353 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio tms_num} @var{tms}
3354 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3355 specified using the configuration command @command{am335xgpio jtag_nums}.
3356 @end deffn
3357
3358 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3359 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3360 specified using the configuration command @command{am335xgpio jtag_nums}.
3361 @end deffn
3362
3363 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3364 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3365 specified using the configuration command @command{am335xgpio jtag_nums}.
3366 @end deffn
3367
3368 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3369 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3370 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3371 @end deffn
3372
3373 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3374 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3375 specified using the configuration command @command{am335xgpio swd_nums}.
3376 @end deffn
3377
3378 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3379 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3380 specified using the configuration command @command{am335xgpio swd_nums}.
3381 @end deffn
3382
3383 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio_dir}
3384 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3385 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin. The direction
3386 control state can be set with the command @command{am335xgpio
3387 swdio_dir_output_state}. If not specified this feature is disabled.
3388 @end deffn
3389
3390 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio swdio_dir_output_state} @var{output_state}
3391 Set the state required for an external SWDIO buffer to be an output. Valid
3392 values are @option{on} (default) and @option{off}.
3393 @end deffn
3394
3395 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio srst_num} @var{srst}
3396 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3397 @end deffn
3398
3399 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio trst_num} @var{trst}
3400 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3401 @end deffn
3402
3403 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio led_num} @var{led}
3404 Set activity LED GPIO number. If not specified an activity LED is not enabled.
3405 @end deffn
3406
3407 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio led_on_state} @var{on_state}
3408 Set required logic level for the LED to be on. Valid values are @option{on}
3409 (default) and @option{off}.
3410 @end deffn
3411
3412 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3413 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified
3414 speed_coeff defaults to 600000 and speed_offset defaults to 575.
3415 @end deffn
3416
3417 @end deffn
3418
3419
3420 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3421 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3422 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3423
3424 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3425 @end deffn
3426
3427
3428 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3429 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3430 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3431
3432 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3433 @end deffn
3434
3435
3436 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3437 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3438 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3439
3440 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3441 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3442 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3443
3444 @itemize @minus
3445 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3446 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3447 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3448 @end itemize
3449 @end deffn
3450
3451 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3452 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3453 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3454 @end deffn
3455 @end deffn
3456
3457
3458 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vdebug}
3459 Cadence Virtual Debug Interface driver.
3460
3461 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug server} host:port
3462 Specifies the host and TCP port number where the vdebug server runs.
3463 @end deffn
3464
3465 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug batching} value
3466 Specifies the batching method for the vdebug request. Possible values are
3467 0 for no batching
3468 1 or wr to batch write transactions together (default)
3469 2 or rw to batch both read and write transactions
3470 @end deffn
3471
3472 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug polling} min max
3473 Takes two values, representing the polling interval in ms. Lower values mean faster
3474 debugger responsiveness, but lower emulation performance. The minimum should be
3475 around 10, maximum should not exceed 1000, which is the default gdb and keepalive
3476 timeout value.
3477 @end deffn
3478
3479 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug bfm_path} path clk_period
3480 Specifies the hierarchical path and input clk period of the vdebug BFM in the design.
3481 The hierarchical path uses Verilog notation top.inst.inst
3482 The clock period must include the unit, for instance 40ns.
3483 @end deffn
3484
3485 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug mem_path} path base size
3486 Specifies the hierarchical path to the design memory instance for backdoor access.
3487 Up to 4 memories can be specified. The hierarchical path uses Verilog notation.
3488 The base specifies start address in the design address space, size its size in bytes.
3489 Both values can use hexadecimal notation with prefix 0x.
3490 @end deffn
3491 @end deffn
3492
3493 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3494 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3495 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3496 DPI server interface.
3497
3498 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3499 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3500 @end deffn
3501
3502 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3503 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3504 @end deffn
3505 @end deffn
3506
3507
3508 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3509
3510 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3511 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3512
3513 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3514 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3515
3516 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3517 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3518 @example
3519 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3520 @end example
3521 @end deffn
3522
3523 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3524 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3525 @example
3526 buspirate speed normal
3527 @end example
3528 @end deffn
3529
3530 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3531 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3532 @itemize @minus
3533 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3534 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3535 @end itemize
3536 For example:
3537 @example
3538 buspirate mode normal
3539 @end example
3540 @end deffn
3541
3542 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3543 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3544 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3545 For example:
3546 @example
3547 buspirate pullup 0
3548 @end example
3549 @end deffn
3550
3551 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3552 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3553 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3554 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3555 @example
3556 buspirate vreg 0
3557 @end example
3558 @end deffn
3559
3560 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3561 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3562 @end deffn
3563 @example
3564 buspirate led 1
3565 @end example
3566
3567 @end deffn
3568
3569
3570 @section Transport Configuration
3571 @cindex Transport
3572 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3573 and the debug adapter you are using,
3574 several transports may be available to
3575 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3576 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3577 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3578 version of OpenOCD.
3579 @end deffn
3580
3581 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3582 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3583
3584 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3585 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3586 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3587 adapter's driver).
3588
3589 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3590 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3591 supported by the debug adapter.
3592
3593 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3594 transport, if any.
3595 @end deffn
3596
3597 @subsection JTAG Transport
3598 @cindex JTAG
3599 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3600 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3601 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3602 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3603 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3604 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3605
3606 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3607 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3608 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3609 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3610 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3611
3612 @subsection SWD Transport
3613 @cindex SWD
3614 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3615 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3616 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3617 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3618 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3619 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3620 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3621
3622 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3623 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3624 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3625 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3626 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3627
3628 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3629 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3630 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3631 expected to change.
3632 @end deffn
3633
3634 @cindex SWD multi-drop
3635 The newer SWD devices (SW-DP v2 or SWJ-DP v2) support the multi-drop extension
3636 of SWD protocol: two or more devices can be connected to one SWD adapter.
3637 SWD transport works in multi-drop mode if @ref{dap_create,DAP} is configured
3638 with both @code{-dp-id} and @code{-instance-id} parameters regardless how many
3639 DAPs are created.
3640
3641 Not all adapters and adapter drivers support SWD multi-drop. Only the following
3642 adapter drivers are SWD multi-drop capable:
3643 cmsis_dap (use an adapter with CMSIS-DAP version 2.0), ftdi, all bitbang based.
3644
3645 @subsection SPI Transport
3646 @cindex SPI
3647 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3648 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3649 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3650 solution for flash programming.
3651
3652 @anchor{swimtransport}
3653 @subsection SWIM Transport
3654 @cindex SWIM
3655 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3656 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3657 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3658 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3659
3660 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3661
3662 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3663
3664 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3665 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3666 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3667 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3668 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3669
3670 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3671 @section JTAG Speed
3672 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3673 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3674 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3675 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3676 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3677 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3678 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3679 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3680 power management software that may be active.
3681
3682 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3683 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3684 target event handler.
3685 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3686 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3687 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3688 sets up those clocks).
3689 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3690 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3691 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3692 in the target config file.
3693 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3694 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3695 config file instead.
3696 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3697 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3698 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3699
3700 @example
3701 jtag_rclk 3000
3702 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3703 @end example
3704
3705 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3706 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3707 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3708 may not be the fastest solution.
3709
3710 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3711 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3712 which support adaptive clocking.
3713
3714 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3715 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3716 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3717 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3718 than the speed specified.
3719
3720 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3721 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3722 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3723 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3724
3725 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3726 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3727 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3728 JTAG clocking after setup.
3729 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3730 If the interface device can not
3731 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3732 @end deffn
3733
3734 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3735 @cindex adaptive clocking
3736 @cindex RTCK
3737 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3738 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3739 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3740 @example
3741 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3742 jtag_rclk 3000
3743 @end example
3744 @end defun
3745
3746 @node Reset Configuration
3747 @chapter Reset Configuration
3748 @cindex Reset Configuration
3749
3750 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3751 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3752 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3753 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3754 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3755 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3756 Please see the various board files for examples.
3757
3758 @quotation Note
3759 To maintainers and integrators:
3760 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3761 Normally the board configuration file
3762 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3763 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3764
3765 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3766 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3767 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3768 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3769 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3770 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3771 @end quotation
3772
3773 @section Types of Reset
3774
3775 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3776 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3777 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3778
3779 @itemize @bullet
3780 @item
3781 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3782 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3783 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3784 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3785 @item
3786 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3787 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3788 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3789 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3790 @item
3791 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3792 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3793 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3794 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3795 @item
3796 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3797 several other types of reset.
3798 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3799 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3800 There may be individual module resets.
3801 @end itemize
3802
3803 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3804 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3805 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3806 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3807 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3808 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3809 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3810 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3811 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3812
3813 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3814 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3815
3816 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3817 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3818 common issues are:
3819
3820 @itemize @bullet
3821
3822 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3823 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3824 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3825 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3826 when either of those signals is not connected.
3827 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3828 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3829 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3830 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3831
3832 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3833 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3834 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3835 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3836
3837 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3838 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3839 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3840 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3841 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3842 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3843 hardware debouncing.
3844 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3845 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3846
3847 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3848 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3849 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3850 to use push/pull output drivers.
3851 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3852 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3853 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3854 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3855
3856 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3857 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3858 issues (not limited to errata).
3859 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3860 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3861 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3862 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3863 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3864 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3865 @end itemize
3866
3867 There can also be other issues.
3868 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3869 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3870 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3871 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3872 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3873 Agreement (NDA).
3874
3875 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3876 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3877 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3878
3879 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3880 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3881
3882 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3883
3884 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3885 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3886 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3887 allowing it to be deasserted.
3888 @end deffn
3889
3890 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3891 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3892 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3893 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3894 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3895 @end deffn
3896
3897 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3898 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3899 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3900 allowing it to be deasserted.
3901 @end deffn
3902
3903 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3904 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3905 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3906 @end deffn
3907
3908 @anchor{reset_config}
3909 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3910 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3911 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3912 configuration scripts.
3913
3914 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3915 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3916 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3917 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3918 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3919 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3920 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3921 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3922
3923 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3924 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3925 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3926 -- may be specified at a time.
3927 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3928 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3929 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3930 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3931 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3932
3933 @itemize
3934 @item
3935 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3936 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3937 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3938 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3939 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3940
3941 @quotation Tip
3942 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3943 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3944 @end quotation
3945
3946 @item
3947 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3948 signal implementations.
3949 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3950 indicating everything behaves normally.
3951 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3952 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3953 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3954 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3955 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3956 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3957 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3958
3959 @item
3960 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3961 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3962 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3963 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3964 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3965 while SRST is asserted.
3966 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3967 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3968
3969 @item
3970 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3971 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3972 is required to use this option.
3973 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3974 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3975 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3976 be asserted before any target connection.
3977 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3978 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3979 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3980 @end itemize
3981
3982 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3983 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3984 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3985 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3986 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3987
3988 @itemize
3989 @item
3990 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3991 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3992 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3993 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3994
3995 @item
3996 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3997 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3998 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3999 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
4000 power-up and pressing a reset button.
4001 @end itemize
4002 @end deffn
4003
4004 @section Custom Reset Handling
4005 @cindex events
4006
4007 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
4008 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
4009 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
4010 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
4011 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
4012 at particular points in the reset sequence.
4013
4014 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
4015 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
4016 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
4017 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
4018 want to reset everything at once.
4019
4020 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
4021 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
4022 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
4023 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
4024 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
4025 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
4026 needs special attention.
4027
4028 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
4029 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
4030 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
4031 to find a sequence of operations that works.
4032 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
4033 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
4034 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
4035 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
4036 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
4037
4038 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
4039 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
4040 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
4041 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
4042 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
4043
4044 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
4045 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
4046 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
4047 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
4048 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
4049 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
4050 low level reset command (@option{halt},
4051 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
4052 or potentially some other value.
4053
4054 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
4055 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
4056 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
4057 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
4058 (or their associated targets)
4059 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
4060
4061 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
4062 they return.
4063 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
4064 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
4065 @end deffn
4066
4067 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
4068 This validates the scan chain using just the four
4069 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
4070 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
4071 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
4072 matches the TAPs it can observe.
4073 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
4074 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
4075 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
4076 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
4077 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
4078 @end deffn
4079
4080 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
4081 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
4082 everything on the JTAG scan chain
4083 (and anything else connected to SRST).
4084 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
4085 @end deffn
4086
4087
4088 @node TAP Declaration
4089 @chapter TAP Declaration
4090 @cindex TAP declaration
4091 @cindex TAP configuration
4092
4093 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
4094 TAPs serve many roles, including:
4095
4096 @itemize @bullet
4097 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
4098 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
4099 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
4100 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
4101 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
4102 start running that code.
4103 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
4104 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
4105 and missing connections.
4106 @end itemize
4107
4108 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
4109 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
4110 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
4111 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
4112 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
4113
4114 @section Scan Chains
4115 @cindex scan chain
4116
4117 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
4118 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
4119 They also need to be added to
4120 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
4121 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
4122 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
4123 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
4124 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
4125 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
4126 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
4127 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
4128
4129 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
4130 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
4131 command, presented in the next chapter.
4132 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
4133 debugging targets.)
4134 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
4135
4136 @verbatim
4137 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
4138 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
4139 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
4140 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
4141 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
4142 @end verbatim
4143
4144 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
4145 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4146 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
4147 because not all devices provide good support for that.
4148 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
4149 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
4150 until they are told to do so.
4151
4152 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
4153 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
4154 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
4155 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
4156
4157 @example
4158 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
4159 @end example
4160
4161 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
4162 by a given chip.
4163 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
4164 and so forth.
4165 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
4166 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
4167 both inside a single chip and between them.
4168 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
4169
4170 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
4171 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
4172 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
4173 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
4174 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
4175 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
4176 includes commands something like this:
4177
4178 @example
4179 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
4180 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
4181 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
4182 @end example
4183
4184 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
4185 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
4186 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
4187
4188 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
4189 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
4190 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
4191 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
4192 @example
4193 foreach t [jtag names] @{
4194 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
4195 @}
4196 @end example
4197 @end deffn
4198
4199 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4200 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4201 and their status.
4202 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4203 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4204 but systems with a JTAG router can
4205 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4206 @end deffn
4207
4208 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4209 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4210
4211 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4212 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4213
4214 @section TAP Names
4215 @cindex dotted name
4216
4217 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4218 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4219 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4220 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4221 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4222 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4223 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4224 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4225
4226 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4227 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4228 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4229
4230 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4231
4232 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4233 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4234 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4235
4236 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4237 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4238 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4239 overridable.
4240
4241 @cindex TAP naming convention
4242 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4243 and should follow this convention:
4244
4245 @itemize @bullet
4246 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4247 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4248 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4249 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4250 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4251 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4252 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4253 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4254 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4255 with a single TAP;
4256 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4257 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4258 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4259 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4260 @end itemize
4261
4262 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4263
4264 @itemize @bullet
4265 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4266 @*The length in bits of the
4267 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4268 @end itemize
4269
4270 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4271
4272 @itemize @bullet
4273 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4274 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4275 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4276 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4277 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4278 (the TAP is linked in).
4279 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4280 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4281 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4282 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4283 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4284 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4285 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4286 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4287 values that were found but not included in the list.
4288
4289 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4290 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4291 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4292 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4293 hardware to find these values.
4294 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4295 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4296 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4297 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4298 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4299 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4300 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4301 @item @code{-ignore-bypass}
4302 @*Specify this to ignore the 'bypass' bit of the idcode. Some vendor put
4303 an invalid idcode regarding this bit. Specify this to ignore this bit and
4304 to not consider this tap in bypass mode.
4305 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4306 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4307 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4308 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4309 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4310 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4311 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4312 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4313 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4314 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4315 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4316 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4317 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4318 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4319 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4320 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4321 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4322 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4323 @end itemize
4324 @end deffn
4325
4326 @section Other TAP commands
4327
4328 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4329 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4330 @end deffn
4331
4332 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4333 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4334 At this writing this TAP attribute
4335 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4336 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4337 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4338 See the next section for information about the available events.
4339
4340 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4341 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4342 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4343 @end deffn
4344
4345 @section TAP Events
4346 @cindex events
4347 @cindex TAP events
4348
4349 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4350 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4351 The other applies to debugger targets,
4352 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4353
4354 The TAP events currently defined are:
4355
4356 @itemize @bullet
4357 @item @b{post-reset}
4358 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4359 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4360 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4361 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4362 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4363
4364 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4365 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4366 of any particular target.
4367 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4368 @item @b{setup}
4369 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4370 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4371 @item @b{tap-disable}
4372 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4373 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4374 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4375 @item @b{tap-enable}
4376 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4377 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4378 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4379 @end itemize
4380
4381 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4382 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4383 contents to be accurate), you might:
4384
4385 @example
4386 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4387 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4388 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4389 @}
4390 @end example
4391
4392
4393 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4394 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4395 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4396 @cindex jrc
4397
4398 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4399 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4400 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4401 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4402 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4403
4404 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4405 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4406 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4407 be visible.
4408 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4409 ignores, such as:
4410
4411 @itemize
4412 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4413 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4414 TAPs receive new instructions.
4415 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4416 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4417 @end itemize
4418
4419 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4420 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4421 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4422 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4423
4424 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4425 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4426
4427 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4428 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4429 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4430 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4431 should define TAP event handlers using
4432 code that looks something like this:
4433
4434 @example
4435 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4436 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4437 @}
4438 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4439 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4440 @}
4441 @end example
4442
4443 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4444
4445 @example
4446 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4447 @end example
4448
4449 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4450 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4451 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4452 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4453
4454 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4455 If necessary, disables the tap
4456 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4457 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4458 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4459 and "0" if it is disabled.
4460 @end deffn
4461
4462 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4463 If necessary, enables the tap
4464 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4465 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4466 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4467 and "0" if it is disabled.
4468 @end deffn
4469
4470 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4471 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4472 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4473 and "0" if it is disabled.
4474
4475 @quotation Note
4476 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4477 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4478 @end quotation
4479 @end deffn
4480
4481 @anchor{autoprobing}
4482 @section Autoprobing
4483 @cindex autoprobe
4484 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4485
4486 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4487 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4488 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4489 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4490
4491 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4492 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4493 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4494 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4495 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4496 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4497 right when they come out of reset).
4498
4499 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4500
4501 @example
4502 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4503 reset_config trst_and_srst
4504 jtag_rclk 8
4505 @end example
4506
4507 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4508 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4509
4510 @enumerate
4511 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4512 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4513 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4514 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4515 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4516 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4517 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4518 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4519 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4520 that is discovered.
4521 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4522 register, it will report it.
4523 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4524 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4525 @end enumerate
4526
4527 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4528 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4529 that's a bit more complex:
4530
4531 @example
4532 clock speed 8 kHz
4533 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4534 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4535 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4536 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4537 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4538 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4539 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4540 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4541 @end example
4542
4543 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4544 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4545 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4546 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4547 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4548 and so forth.
4549
4550 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4551 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4552 @cindex DAP declaration
4553
4554 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4555 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4556 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4557 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4558 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4559
4560 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4561
4562 @anchor{dap_create}
4563 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4564 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4565 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4566 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4567 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4568
4569 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4570
4571 @itemize @bullet
4572 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4573 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4574 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4575 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4576 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4577
4578 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4579 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4580 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4581 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4582 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4583 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4584
4585 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4586 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4587 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4588 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4589 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4590 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4591 @end itemize
4592 @end deffn
4593
4594 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4595 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4596 for TCL scripting.
4597 @end deffn
4598
4599 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4600 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4601 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4602 @end deffn
4603
4604 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4605 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4606 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4607 initialization, too.
4608 @end deffn
4609
4610 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4611
4612 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4613 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4614 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4615 @end deffn
4616
4617 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4618 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4619 @end deffn
4620
4621 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4622 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4623 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4624 or set a new value @var{value}.
4625 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4626 @end deffn
4627
4628 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4629 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4630 @end deffn
4631
4632 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4633 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4634 value @var{value}.
4635
4636 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4637 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4638 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4639
4640 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4641 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4642 @end deffn
4643
4644 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4645 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4646 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4647 @end deffn
4648
4649 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4650 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4651 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4652 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4653 @end deffn
4654
4655 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4656 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4657
4658 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4659 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4660 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4661 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4662 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4663 for details.
4664
4665 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4666 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4667 the pattern:
4668 @example
4669 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4670 @end example
4671
4672 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4673 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4674 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4675 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4676 @example
4677 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr @{1 << 27@}]
4678 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4679 @end example
4680
4681 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4682 @example
4683 set CSW_SPROT [expr @{1 << 30@}]
4684 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4685 @end example
4686
4687 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4688 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4689
4690 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4691 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4692 example with a proper dap name:
4693 @example
4694 xxx.dap apcsw default
4695 @end example
4696 @end deffn
4697
4698 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4699 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4700 Disabled by default
4701 @end deffn
4702
4703
4704 @node CPU Configuration
4705 @chapter CPU Configuration
4706 @cindex GDB target
4707
4708 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4709 You can also access these targets without GDB
4710 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4711 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4712 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4713 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4714
4715 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4716 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4717
4718 @section Target List
4719 @cindex target, current
4720 @cindex target, list
4721
4722 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4723 where each member has a name.
4724 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4725 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4726 (plural!) command.
4727 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4728 look like with more than one:
4729 @verbatim
4730 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4731 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4732 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4733 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4734 @end verbatim
4735
4736 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4737 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4738 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4739 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4740 space seen by that current target.
4741 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4742 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4743 are examples; and there are many more.
4744
4745 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4746
4747 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4748 Returns the name of the current target.
4749 @end deffn
4750
4751 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4752 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4753 @example
4754 foreach t [target names] @{
4755 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4756 @}
4757 @end example
4758 @end deffn
4759
4760 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4761 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4762
4763 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4764 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4765 command names are singular.}
4766
4767 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4768 targets in a user friendly form.
4769
4770 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4771 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4772 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4773 @end deffn
4774
4775 @section Target CPU Types
4776 @cindex target type
4777 @cindex CPU type
4778
4779 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4780 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4781 when calling @command{target create}.
4782 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4783 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4784 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4785 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4786 what core-specific commands may be available
4787 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4788 and more.
4789
4790 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4791 since there's a command to list them.
4792
4793 @anchor{targettypes}
4794 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4795 Lists all supported target types.
4796 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4797
4798 @itemize @bullet
4799 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4800 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4801 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4802 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4803 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4804 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4805 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4806 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4807 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4808 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4809 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4810 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4811 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4812 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4813 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4814 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4815 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4816 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4817 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4818 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4819 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4820 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4821 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4822 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4823 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4824 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4825 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4826 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4827 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4828 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4829 support for new CPUs.
4830 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4831 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4832 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4833 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4834 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4835 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core (deprecated; would be removed in v0.13.0).
4836 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core (deprecated; would be removed in v0.13.0).
4837 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core (deprecated; would be removed in v0.13.0).
4838 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4839 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4840 @itemize @minus
4841 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4842 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4843 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4844 @end itemize
4845 And two debug interfaces cores:
4846 @itemize @minus
4847 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4848 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4849 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4850 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4851 @end itemize
4852 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4853 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4854 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4855 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4856 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4857 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4858 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4859 @end itemize
4860 @end deffn
4861
4862 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4863 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4864 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4865 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4866 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4867 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4868 reflect design generations;
4869 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4870 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4871
4872 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4873 @section Target Configuration
4874
4875 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4876 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4877 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4878 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4879 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4880
4881 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4882 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4883 optional parts.
4884 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4885 command, created as part of target creation.
4886
4887 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4888 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4889 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4890 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4891 to be much more board-specific.
4892 The key steps you use might look something like this
4893
4894 @example
4895 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4896 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4897 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4898 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4899 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4900 @end example
4901
4902 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4903 on-chip SRAM.
4904 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4905 writes to target memory;
4906 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4907 GDB memory checksumming;
4908 and more.
4909
4910 @quotation Warning
4911 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4912 inaccessible when application code
4913 (such as an operating system)
4914 enables or disables the MMU.
4915 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4916 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4917 easy access to other addresses needed.
4918 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4919 @end quotation
4920
4921 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4922 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4923 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4924 controllers.
4925 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4926 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4927 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4928
4929 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4930 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4931 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4932 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4933 purposes including additional configuration.
4934
4935 @itemize @bullet
4936 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4937 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4938 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4939 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4940
4941 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4942 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4943 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4944 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4945 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4946 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4947 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4948
4949 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4950 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4951 @end itemize
4952 @end deffn
4953
4954 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4955 The options accepted by this command may also be
4956 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4957 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4958 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4959
4960 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4961 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4962 and changing its endianness.
4963
4964 @itemize @bullet
4965
4966 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4967 used to access this target.
4968
4969 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4970 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4971 create and manage DAP instances.
4972
4973 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4974 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4975
4976 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4977 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4978 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4979 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4980 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4981 same event name assigns only one handler.
4982
4983 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4984 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4985
4986 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4987 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4988 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4989 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4990 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4991 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4992 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4993
4994 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4995 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4996 or virtual address is being used.
4997
4998 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4999 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
5000
5001 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
5002 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
5003 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
5004 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
5005 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
5006
5007 @anchor{rtostype}
5008 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
5009 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
5010 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
5011 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
5012 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
5013 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
5014
5015 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
5016 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
5017 access the target for debugging.
5018
5019 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
5020 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
5021 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
5022 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
5023
5024 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
5025 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
5026 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
5027 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
5028 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
5029
5030 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
5031 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
5032 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
5033 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
5034 command @command{gdb_port}.
5035 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
5036
5037 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
5038 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
5039 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
5040 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
5041 @end itemize
5042 @end deffn
5043
5044 @section Other $target_name Commands
5045 @cindex object command
5046
5047 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
5048 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
5049
5050 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
5051 Once a button is created a button
5052 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
5053 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
5054 configure it like this:
5055
5056 @example
5057 # Create
5058 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
5059 # Modify
5060 .foobar configure -foreground blue
5061 # Query
5062 set x [.foobar cget -background]
5063 # Report
5064 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
5065 @end example
5066
5067 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
5068 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
5069
5070 @example
5071 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
5072 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
5073 @end example
5074
5075 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
5076
5077 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
5078 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
5079 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
5080 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
5081 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
5082 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
5083 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
5084 They are not otherwise documented here.
5085 @end deffn
5086
5087 @deffn {Command} {$target_name set_reg} dict
5088 Set register values of the target.
5089
5090 @itemize
5091 @item @var{dict} ... Tcl dictionary with pairs of register names and values.
5092 @end itemize
5093
5094 For example, the following command sets the value 0 to the program counter (pc)
5095 register and 0x1000 to the stack pointer (sp) register:
5096
5097 @example
5098 set_reg @{pc 0 sp 0x1000@}
5099 @end example
5100 @end deffn
5101
5102 @deffn {Command} {$target_name get_reg} [-force] list
5103 Get register values from the target and return them as Tcl dictionary with pairs
5104 of register names and values.
5105 If option "-force" is set, the register values are read directly from the
5106 target, bypassing any caching.
5107
5108 @itemize
5109 @item @var{list} ... List of register names
5110 @end itemize
5111
5112 For example, the following command retrieves the values from the program
5113 counter (pc) and stack pointer (sp) register:
5114
5115 @example
5116 get_reg @{pc sp@}
5117 @end example
5118 @end deffn
5119
5120 @deffn {Command} {$target_name write_memory} address width data ['phys']
5121 This function provides an efficient way to write to the target memory from a Tcl
5122 script.
5123
5124 @itemize
5125 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
5126 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
5127 @item @var{data} ... Tcl list with the elements to write
5128 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
5129 @end itemize
5130
5131 For example, the following command writes two 32 bit words into the target
5132 memory at address 0x20000000:
5133
5134 @example
5135 write_memory 0x20000000 32 @{0xdeadbeef 0x00230500@}
5136 @end example
5137 @end deffn
5138
5139 @deffn {Command} {$target_name read_memory} address width count ['phys']
5140 This function provides an efficient way to read the target memory from a Tcl
5141 script.
5142 A Tcl list containing the requested memory elements is returned by this function.
5143
5144 @itemize
5145 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
5146 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
5147 @item @var{count} ... number of elements to read
5148 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
5149 @end itemize
5150
5151 For example, the following command reads two 32 bit words from the target
5152 memory at address 0x20000000:
5153
5154 @example
5155 read_memory 0x20000000 32 2
5156 @end example
5157 @end deffn
5158
5159 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
5160 Each configuration parameter accepted by
5161 @command{$target_name configure}
5162 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
5163 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
5164 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
5165 There are a few special cases:
5166
5167 @itemize @bullet
5168 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
5169 event named @var{event_name}.
5170 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
5171 two parameters.
5172 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
5173 This is a special case because this is set using
5174 @command{target create} and can't be changed
5175 using @command{$target_name configure}.
5176 @end itemize
5177
5178 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
5179 all the targets you might use something like this:
5180
5181 @example
5182 foreach name [target names] @{
5183 set y [$name cget -endian]
5184 set z [$name cget -type]
5185 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
5186 $x $name $y $z]
5187 @}
5188 @end example
5189 @end deffn
5190
5191 @anchor{targetcurstate}
5192 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
5193 Displays the current target state:
5194 @code{debug-running},
5195 @code{halted},
5196 @code{reset},
5197 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
5198 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
5199 @end deffn
5200
5201 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
5202 Displays a table listing all event handlers
5203 currently associated with this target.
5204 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
5205 @end deffn
5206
5207 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
5208 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
5209 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
5210 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
5211 @end deffn
5212
5213 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
5214 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
5215 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
5216 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
5217 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5218 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
5219 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5220 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5221 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5222 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5223 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5224 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5225 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5226 (If you want to process the data instead of displaying it,
5227 see the @code{read_memory} primitives.)
5228 @end deffn
5229
5230 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
5231 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
5232 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
5233 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
5234 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5235 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
5236 at the specified address @var{addr}.
5237 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5238 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5239 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5240 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5241 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
5242 @end deffn
5243
5244 @anchor{targetevents}
5245 @section Target Events
5246 @cindex target events
5247 @cindex events
5248 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
5249 For example:
5250 @itemize @bullet
5251 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
5252 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
5253 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5254 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5255 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5256 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5257 to set up system clocks or
5258 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5259 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5260 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5261 @end itemize
5262
5263 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5264 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5265 @command{target create ... -event}.
5266
5267 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5268 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5269 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5270
5271 @example
5272 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5273 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5274 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5275 @}
5276 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5277 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5278 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5279 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5280 @}
5281 @end example
5282
5283 The following target events are defined:
5284
5285 @itemize @bullet
5286 @item @b{debug-halted}
5287 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5288 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5289 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5290 @item @b{early-halted}
5291 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5292 @item @b{examine-start}
5293 @* Before target examine is called.
5294 @item @b{examine-end}
5295 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5296 @item @b{examine-fail}
5297 @* After target examine fails.
5298 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5299 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5300 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5301 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5302 connect GDB to running target.
5303 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5304 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5305 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5306 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5307 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5308 is in RAM or read only memory.
5309 Default is @code{halt}
5310 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5311 @* When GDB disconnects
5312 @item @b{gdb-end}
5313 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5314 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5315 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5316 @code{reset init})
5317 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5318 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5319 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5320 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5321 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5322 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5323 @item @b{gdb-start}
5324 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5325 @item @b{halted}
5326 @* The target has halted
5327 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5328 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5329 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5330 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5331 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5332 @item @b{reset-assert}
5333 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5334 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5335 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5336 it instead of asserting SRST.
5337 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5338 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5339 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5340 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5341 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5342 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5343 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5344 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5345 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5346 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5347 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5348 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5349 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5350 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5351 released on the scan chain.
5352 @item @b{reset-end}
5353 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5354 @item @b{reset-init}
5355 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5356 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5357
5358 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5359 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5360 multiplexing, and so on.
5361 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5362 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5363 @item @b{reset-start}
5364 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5365 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5366
5367 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5368 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5369 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5370 @item @b{resume-start}
5371 @* Before any target is resumed
5372 @item @b{resume-end}
5373 @* After all targets have resumed
5374 @item @b{resumed}
5375 @* Target has resumed
5376 @item @b{step-start}
5377 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5378 @item @b{step-end}
5379 @* After single-step has completed
5380 @item @b{trace-config}
5381 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5382 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x100}
5383 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x100
5384 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x101}
5385 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x101
5386 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x102}
5387 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x102
5388 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x103}
5389 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x103
5390 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x104}
5391 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x104
5392 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x105}
5393 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x105
5394 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x106}
5395 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x106
5396 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x107}
5397 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x107
5398 @end itemize
5399
5400 @quotation Note
5401 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5402 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5403 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5404 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5405 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5406 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5407 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5408 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5409 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5410 check if the core has changed status.
5411 @end quotation
5412
5413 @node Flash Commands
5414 @chapter Flash Commands
5415
5416 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5417 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5418 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5419 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5420 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5421 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5422 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5423 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5424 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5425
5426 Flash Steps:
5427 @enumerate
5428 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5429 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5430 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5431 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5432 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5433 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5434 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5435 @item GDB Flashing
5436 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5437 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5438 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5439 @end enumerate
5440
5441 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5442 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5443 so that it can't boot.
5444 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5445 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5446
5447 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5448 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5449 @cindex flash configuration
5450
5451 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5452 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5453 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5454 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5455 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5456 see the driver-specific documentation.
5457
5458 @itemize @bullet
5459 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5460 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5461 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5462 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5463 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5464 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5465 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5466 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5467 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5468 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5469 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5470 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5471 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5472 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5473 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5474 commands to the flash controller.
5475 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5476 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5477 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5478 for more information.
5479 @end itemize
5480 @quotation Note
5481 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5482 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5483 @end quotation
5484 @end deffn
5485
5486 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5487 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5488 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5489 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5490 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5491 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5492 @end deffn
5493
5494 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5495 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5496 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5497 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5498 @end deffn
5499
5500 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5501 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5502 depends on the flash type.
5503 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5504 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5505 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5506 but most don't bother.
5507 @end deffn
5508
5509 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5510
5511 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5512 begins.
5513
5514 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5515 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5516 until the programming session is finished.
5517
5518 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5519 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5520
5521 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5522
5523 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5524 @cindex flash erasing
5525 @cindex flash reading
5526 @cindex flash writing
5527 @cindex flash programming
5528 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5529
5530 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5531 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5532 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5533 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5534 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5535
5536 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5537 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5538 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5539 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5540 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5541
5542 @quotation Note
5543 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5544 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5545 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5546 back to a flash bank.
5547 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5548 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5549 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5550 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5551 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5552 @end quotation
5553
5554 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5555 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5556 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5557 disabled first.
5558 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5559 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5560 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5561
5562 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5563 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5564 up to and including @var{last}.
5565 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5566 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5567 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5568 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5569 @end deffn
5570
5571 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5572 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5573 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5574 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5575 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5576 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5577 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5578 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5579 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5580 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5581 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5582 before erase starts.
5583 @end deffn
5584
5585 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5586 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5587 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5588 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5589 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5590 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5591 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5592 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5593 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5594 before issuing this command.
5595 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5596 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5597 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5598 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5599 @end deffn
5600 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5601
5602 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5603 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5604 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5605 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5606 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5607 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5608 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5609 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5610 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5611 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5612 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5613 @end deffn
5614
5615 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5616 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5617 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5618 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5619 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5620 @end deffn
5621
5622 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5623 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5624 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5625 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5626 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5627 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5628 @end deffn
5629
5630 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5631 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5632 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5633 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5634 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5635 @end deffn
5636
5637 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5638 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5639 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5640 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5641 to the base address for each section in the image.
5642 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5643 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5644 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5645 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5646 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5647 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5648 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5649 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5650 each image section.
5651
5652 @quotation Warning
5653 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5654 data you want to preserve.
5655 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5656 sections might be erased with no notice.
5657 @itemize
5658 @item
5659 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5660 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5661 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5662 @item
5663 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5664 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5665 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5666 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5667 @end itemize
5668 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5669 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5670 @end quotation
5671
5672 @end deffn
5673
5674 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5675 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5676 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5677 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5678 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5679 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5680 ordinary memory reads.
5681 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5682 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5683 check for successful programming.
5684 @end deffn
5685
5686 @section Other Flash commands
5687 @cindex flash protection
5688
5689 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5690 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5691 and display that status.
5692 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5693 @end deffn
5694
5695 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5696 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5697 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5698
5699 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5700 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5701 and possibly stale information.
5702 @end deffn
5703
5704 @anchor{flashprotect}
5705 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5706 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5707 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5708 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5709 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5710 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5711 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5712 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5713 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5714 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5715 @end deffn
5716
5717 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5718 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5719 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5720 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5721 @end deffn
5722
5723 @anchor{program}
5724 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5725 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5726 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5727 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5728 @end deffn
5729
5730 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5731 @section Flash Driver List
5732 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5733 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5734 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5735
5736 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5737 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5738 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5739
5740 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5741
5742 @itemize
5743 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5744 @end itemize
5745
5746 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5747 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5748 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5749 @example
5750 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5751 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5752 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5753 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5754 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5755 @end example
5756 @end deffn
5757
5758 @subsection External Flash
5759
5760 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5761 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5762 @cindex CFI
5763 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5764 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5765 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5766 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5767 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5768 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5769 configure a bus and its timings), or
5770 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5771 on the flash chip.
5772 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5773 speed up operation.
5774
5775 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5776
5777 @itemize
5778 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5779 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5780 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5781 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5782 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5783 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5784 @end itemize
5785
5786 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5787 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5788
5789 @example
5790 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5791 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5792 @end example
5793
5794 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5795 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5796 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5797
5798 @example
5799 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5800 @end example
5801
5802 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5803 @end deffn
5804
5805 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5806 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5807 @cindex SPI
5808 @cindex jtagspi
5809 @cindex bscan_spi
5810 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5811 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5812 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5813 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5814 accessed through JTAG.
5815
5816 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5817 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5818 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5819 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5820 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5821 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5822
5823 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5824 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5825 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5826 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5827 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5828 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5829 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5830 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5831
5832 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5833 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5834 command, see below.
5835
5836 @itemize
5837 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5838 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5839 @var{USER1} instruction.
5840 @end itemize
5841
5842 @example
5843 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5844 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5845 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5846 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5847 @end example
5848
5849 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5850 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
5851 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5852 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
5853 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5854 @example
5855 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
5856 @end example
5857 @end deffn
5858
5859 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5860 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
5861 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
5862 @example
5863 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
5864 @end example
5865 @end deffn
5866
5867 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
5868 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
5869 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
5870 @end deffn
5871 @end deffn
5872
5873 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5874 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5875 @cindex xcf
5876 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5877 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5878 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5879 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5880 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5881
5882 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5883 command accepts additional parameters:
5884 @itemize
5885 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5886 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5887 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5888 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5889 in master mode.
5890 @end itemize
5891 @example
5892 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5893 @end example
5894 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5895 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5896 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5897 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5898 dedicated sector.
5899 @end deffn
5900
5901 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5902 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5903 button.
5904 @example
5905 xcf configure 0
5906 @end example
5907 @end deffn
5908
5909 Additional driver notes:
5910 @itemize
5911 @item Only single revision supported.
5912 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5913 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5914 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5915 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5916 @end itemize
5917 @end deffn
5918
5919 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5920 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5921 @cindex SPIFI
5922 @cindex lpcspifi
5923 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5924 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5925 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5926
5927 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5928 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5929 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5930 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5931 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5932
5933 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5934 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5935 are configured by the driver.
5936
5937 @example
5938 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5939 @end example
5940
5941 @end deffn
5942
5943 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5944 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5945 @cindex SMI
5946 @cindex stmsmi
5947 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5948 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5949 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5950 SPI flash devices.
5951 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5952 flash devices can be connected.
5953
5954 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5955 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5956 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5957 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5958 the flash content.
5959
5960 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5961 to identify the memory bank.
5962 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5963 flash size, are detected automatically.
5964
5965 @example
5966 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5967 @end example
5968
5969 @end deffn
5970
5971 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
5972 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5973 @cindex QuadSPI
5974 @cindex OctoSPI
5975 @cindex stmqspi
5976 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5977 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5978 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5979 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5980 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5981 mode is not.
5982
5983 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5984 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5985 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5986 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5987
5988 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5989 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5990 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5991
5992 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5993 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5994 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5995 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5996 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5997 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5998
5999 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
6000 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
6001 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
6002 should be avoided.
6003
6004 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
6005 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
6006 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
6007 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
6008 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
6009 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
6010
6011 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
6012 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
6013 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
6014 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
6015 persist across openocd invocations.
6016
6017 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
6018 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
6019 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
6020 required (see 'set' command).
6021
6022 @example
6023 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
6024 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
6025 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
6026 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
6027 @end example
6028
6029 There are three specific commands
6030 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
6031 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
6032 chip specific write protection engaged.
6033 @end deffn
6034
6035 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
6036 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
6037 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
6038 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
6039 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
6040 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
6041
6042 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
6043 which don't support an id command.
6044
6045 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
6046 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
6047 @end deffn
6048
6049 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
6050 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
6051 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
6052 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
6053 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
6054
6055 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
6056 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
6057 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
6058 @var{resp_num} must be even.
6059
6060 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
6061
6062 To check basic communication settings, issue
6063 @example
6064 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
6065 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
6066 @end example
6067 for single flash mode or
6068 @example
6069 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
6070 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
6071 @end example
6072 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
6073
6074 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
6075 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
6076 need a dummy address, e.g.
6077 @example
6078 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
6079 @end example
6080 should return the status register contents.
6081
6082 @end deffn
6083
6084 @end deffn
6085
6086 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
6087 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
6088 Microcontroller platform.
6089
6090 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
6091 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
6092
6093 @example
6094 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
6095 @end example
6096
6097 @end deffn
6098
6099 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
6100 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
6101 @cindex ath79
6102 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
6103 chip selects.
6104 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
6105 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
6106 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
6107 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
6108 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
6109 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
6110
6111 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
6112 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
6113 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
6114 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
6115 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
6116 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
6117 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
6118 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
6119 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
6120 with the default CS0.
6121 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
6122 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
6123 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
6124
6125 @example
6126 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6127
6128 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
6129 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
6130 # distinguish the banks.
6131 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
6132 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
6133 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
6134 @end example
6135
6136 @end deffn
6137
6138 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
6139 @cindex Freedom E SPI
6140 @cindex fespi
6141
6142 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
6143
6144 @example
6145 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6146 @end example
6147 @end deffn
6148
6149 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
6150
6151 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
6152 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
6153 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6154 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
6155 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
6156 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
6157
6158 @example
6159 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6160 @end example
6161 @end deffn
6162
6163 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
6164 @cindex ambiqmicro
6165 @cindex apollo
6166 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
6167 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6168 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
6169 with the target using SWD.
6170
6171 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
6172 the device class of the MCU.
6173 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
6174 to set up the flash banks.
6175 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
6176 sizes of an Apollo chip.
6177
6178 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
6179 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
6180 and the second bank starts after the first.
6181
6182 @example
6183 # Flash bank 0
6184 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6185 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
6186 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
6187 $_TARGETNAME
6188 @end example
6189
6190 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
6191 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
6192 are available to the user.
6193
6194 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
6195
6196 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
6197 Erase entire bank.
6198 @end deffn
6199 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
6200 Erase device pages.
6201 @end deffn
6202 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
6203 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
6204 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
6205 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
6206 the flash.
6207 @end deffn
6208 @end deffn
6209
6210 @anchor{at91samd}
6211 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
6212 @cindex at91samd
6213 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
6214 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
6215
6216 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
6217
6218 The devices have one flash bank:
6219
6220 @example
6221 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6222 @end example
6223
6224 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
6225 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6226 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6227 processor to be halted.
6228 @end deffn
6229
6230 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
6231 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
6232 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
6233 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
6234 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
6235 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
6236
6237 @example
6238 at91samd set-security enable
6239 @end example
6240 @end deffn
6241
6242 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
6243 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
6244 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
6245 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
6246 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
6247 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
6248 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
6249 in order to disable this feature.
6250
6251 @example
6252 at91samd eeprom
6253 at91samd eeprom 1024
6254 @end example
6255 @end deffn
6256
6257 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
6258 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
6259 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6260 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
6261 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
6262 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6263
6264 @example
6265 at91samd bootloader
6266 at91samd bootloader 16384
6267 @end example
6268 @end deffn
6269
6270 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
6271 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6272 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6273 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6274 @end deffn
6275
6276 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
6277 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
6278 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6279 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6280 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6281 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6282 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6283 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6284
6285 @example
6286 # Read user row
6287 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6288 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6289 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6290 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6291 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6292 # byte unchanged
6293 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6294 @end example
6295 @end deffn
6296
6297 @end deffn
6298
6299 @anchor{at91sam3}
6300 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6301 @cindex at91sam3
6302 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6303 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6304 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6305 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6306 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6307 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6308 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6309 chips are confirmed.}
6310
6311 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6312 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6313 the following fixed locations:
6314
6315 @example
6316 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6317 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6318 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6319 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6320 @end example
6321
6322 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6323 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6324 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6325
6326 @itemize
6327 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6328 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6329 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6330 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6331 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6332 @end itemize
6333
6334 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6335
6336 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6337 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6338 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6339 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6340 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6341 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6342 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6343
6344 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6345 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6346 @end deffn
6347
6348 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6349 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6350 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6351 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6352 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6353 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6354 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6355 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6356 @end deffn
6357
6358 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6359 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6360 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6361 @end deffn
6362 @end deffn
6363
6364 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6365 @cindex at91sam4
6366 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6367 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6368 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6369 @end deffn
6370
6371 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6372 @cindex at91sam4l
6373 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6374 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6375 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6376
6377 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6378 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6379 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6380 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6381 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6382 @end deffn
6383 @end deffn
6384
6385 @anchor{atsame5}
6386 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6387 @cindex atsame5
6388 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6389 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6390 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6391
6392 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6393 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6394 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6395
6396 @example
6397 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6398 @end example
6399
6400 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6401 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6402 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6403 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6404 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6405 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6406
6407 @example
6408 atsame5 bootloader
6409 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6410 @end example
6411 @end deffn
6412
6413 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6414 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6415 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6416 processor to be halted.
6417 @end deffn
6418
6419 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6420 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6421 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6422 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6423 @end deffn
6424
6425 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6426 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6427 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6428 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6429 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6430 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6431 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6432 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6433
6434 @example
6435 # Read
6436 >atsame5 userpage
6437 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6438 # Write
6439 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6440 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6441 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6442 # bytes)
6443 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6444 @end example
6445 @end deffn
6446
6447 @end deffn
6448
6449 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6450 @cindex atsamv
6451 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6452 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6453 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6454
6455 @example
6456 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsamv 0x00400000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6457 @end example
6458
6459 @deffn {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} [@option{show} [@option{all}|number]]
6460 @deffnx {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} (@option{clr}|@option{set}) number
6461 With no parameters, @option{show} or @option{show all},
6462 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6463 With @option{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6464
6465 With @option{set} @var{number} or @option{clear} @var{number},
6466 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6467 @end deffn
6468
6469 @end deffn
6470
6471 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6472 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6473 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6474 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6475 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6476
6477 @example
6478 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6479 @end example
6480
6481 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6482 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6483
6484 @itemize
6485 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6486 @item @var{banks}
6487 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6488 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6489 @item @var{pages_size}
6490 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6491 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6492 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6493 @end itemize
6494
6495 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6496 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6497 will be autoconfigured.
6498 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6499
6500 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6501 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6502 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6503 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6504 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6505
6506 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6507 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6508 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6509 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6510 are not truly general purpose).
6511 @quotation Note
6512 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6513 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6514 @end quotation
6515 @end deffn
6516 @end deffn
6517
6518 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6519 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6520 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6521 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6522 @end deffn
6523
6524 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6525 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP/LPS Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6526 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6527 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6528
6529 @example
6530 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6531 @end example
6532
6533 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6534 each single sector one by one.
6535
6536 @example
6537 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6538 @end example
6539
6540 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6541 @end deffn
6542
6543 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6544 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6545 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6546 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6547 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6548 starts at address 0.
6549
6550 @example
6551 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6552 @end example
6553 @end deffn
6554
6555 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6556 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6557 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6558 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6559 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6560 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6561 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6562 and programming the serial flash.
6563
6564 @example
6565 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6566 @end example
6567 @end deffn
6568
6569 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6570 All members of the EFM32/EFR32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro (now Silicon Labs)
6571 include internal flash and use Arm Cortex-M3 or Cortex-M4 cores. The driver automatically
6572 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6573 autoconfigures itself.
6574 @example
6575 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6576 @end example
6577 It supports writing to the user data page, as well as the portion of the lockbits page
6578 past 512 bytes on chips with larger page sizes. The latter is used by the SiLabs
6579 bootloader/AppLoader system for encryption keys. Setting protection on these pages is
6580 currently not supported.
6581 @example
6582 flash bank userdata.flash efm32 0x0FE00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6583 flash bank lockbits.flash efm32 0x0FE04000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6584 @end example
6585
6586 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6587 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6588 this via the following command:
6589 @example
6590 efm32 debuglock num
6591 @end example
6592 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6593 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6594 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6595 supported.}
6596 @end deffn
6597
6598 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6599 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6600 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6601 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6602 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6603 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6604
6605 @example
6606 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6607 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6608 @end example
6609
6610 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6611 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6612 @end deffn
6613
6614 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6615 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6616 is an uncommon operation.}
6617 @end deffn
6618 @end deffn
6619
6620 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6621 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6622 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6623 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6624 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6625 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6626 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6627
6628 @example
6629 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6630 @end example
6631 @end deffn
6632
6633 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6634 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6635 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6636 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6637 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6638 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6639 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6640 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6641 characters) ignored.
6642
6643 @example
6644 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6645 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6646 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6647 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6648 @end example
6649 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6650 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6651 @end deffn
6652
6653 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6654 @cindex kinetis
6655 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6656 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6657 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6658 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6659 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6660 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6661
6662 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6663 @itemize
6664 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6665 @end itemize
6666
6667 @example
6668 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6669 @end example
6670
6671 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6672 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6673 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6674 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6675 @end deffn
6676
6677 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6678 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6679 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6680 set by 'flash protect' command.
6681 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6682 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6683 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6684 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6685 with the rest of a flash image.
6686 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6687 @end deffn
6688
6689 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6690 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6691 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6692 @end deffn
6693
6694 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6695 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6696 and examine-fail event.
6697 @end deffn
6698
6699 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6700 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6701 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6702 @end deffn
6703
6704 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6705 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6706 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6707 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6708 command completes.
6709 @end deffn
6710
6711 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6712 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6713 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6714 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6715 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6716
6717 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6718 Program Partition command.
6719
6720 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6721 Reset the device after partition setting.
6722
6723 Show partition size:
6724 @example
6725 kinetis nvm_partition info
6726 @end example
6727
6728 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6729 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6730 @example
6731 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6732 @end example
6733
6734 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6735 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6736 @example
6737 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6738 @end example
6739 @end deffn
6740
6741 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6742 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6743 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6744 @end deffn
6745
6746 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6747 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6748 Command disables watchdog timer.
6749 @end deffn
6750 @end deffn
6751
6752 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6753 @cindex kinetis_ke
6754 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6755 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6756 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6757 autoconfigures itself.
6758 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6759
6760 @example
6761 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6762 @end example
6763
6764 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6765 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6766 @end deffn
6767
6768 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6769 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6770 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6771 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6772 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6773 @end deffn
6774
6775 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6776 Command disables watchdog timer.
6777 @end deffn
6778 @end deffn
6779
6780 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6781 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6782 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6783 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6784 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6785
6786 @quotation Note
6787 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6788 driver:
6789 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6790 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6791 @end quotation
6792
6793 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6794 which must appear in the following order:
6795
6796 @itemize
6797 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6798 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6799 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6800 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6801 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6802 LPC43x[2357])
6803 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6804 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6805 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6806 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6807 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6808 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6809 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6810 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6811 at which the core is running
6812 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6813 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6814 @quotation Note
6815 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6816 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6817 However, if you do provide it,
6818 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6819 @end quotation
6820 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6821 ROM IAP entry point.
6822 @end itemize
6823
6824 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6825
6826 @example
6827 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6828 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6829 @end example
6830
6831 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6832 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6833 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6834 @end deffn
6835 @end deffn
6836
6837 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6838 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6839 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6840 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6841 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6842 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6843
6844 @example
6845 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6846 @end example
6847 @end deffn
6848
6849 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6850 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6851 from NXP.
6852
6853 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6854 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6855 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6856 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6857 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6858 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6859 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6860 you start the PLL.
6861
6862 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6863
6864 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6865 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6866 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6867
6868 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6869 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6870 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6871 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6872 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6873 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6874 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6875
6876 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6877 @example
6878 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6879 @end example
6880
6881 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6882 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6883 @code{flash banks} command.
6884
6885 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6886 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6887 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6888 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6889 a known signature.
6890 Example:
6891 @example
6892 lpc2900 signature 0
6893 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6894 @end example
6895 @end deffn
6896
6897 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6898 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6899 saves it to a file in binary format.
6900 Example:
6901 @example
6902 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6903 @end example
6904 @end deffn
6905
6906 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6907 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6908 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6909 command:
6910
6911 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6912 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6913 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6914 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6915
6916 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6917 Example:
6918 @example
6919 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6920 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6921 @end example
6922 @end deffn
6923
6924 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6925 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6926 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6927 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6928 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6929 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6930 912 bytes.
6931 @quotation Attention
6932 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6933 @end quotation
6934 Example:
6935 @example
6936 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6937 @end example
6938 @end deffn
6939
6940 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6941 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6942 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6943 after the next power cycle.
6944 @quotation Attention
6945 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6946 @end quotation
6947 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6948 Example:
6949 @example
6950 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6951 flash info 0
6952 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6953 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6954 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6955 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6956 @end example
6957 @end deffn
6958
6959 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6960 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6961 effective after the next power cycle.
6962 @quotation Attention
6963 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6964 @end quotation
6965 Examples:
6966 @example
6967 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6968 @end example
6969 @end deffn
6970 @end deffn
6971
6972 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
6973 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6974 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6975 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6976
6977 @example
6978 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6979 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6980 @end example
6981
6982 @itemize @bullet
6983 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6984 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6985 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6986 @end itemize
6987
6988 Example usage:
6989 @example
6990 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6991 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6992 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6993 @} else @{
6994 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6995 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6996 @}
6997 @end example
6998 @end deffn
6999
7000 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
7001 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
7002 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
7003 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
7004 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
7005 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
7006
7007 @example
7008 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7009 @end example
7010
7011 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
7012 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
7013 only the main program flash.
7014
7015 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
7016 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
7017 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
7018 @end deffn
7019
7020 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
7021 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
7022 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
7023 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
7024
7025 To erase and program the BSL:
7026 @example
7027 msp432 bsl unlock
7028 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
7029 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
7030 msp432 bsl lock
7031 @end example
7032 @end deffn
7033 @end deffn
7034
7035 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
7036 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
7037 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
7038 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
7039 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
7040 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
7041 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
7042 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
7043 also have division into regions: main and info.
7044 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
7045 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
7046
7047 @example
7048 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7049 @end example
7050
7051 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
7052
7053 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
7054 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
7055 @end deffn
7056
7057 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
7058 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
7059 @end deffn
7060
7061 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
7062 Erase all userflash including info region.
7063 @end deffn
7064
7065 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
7066 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
7067 @end deffn
7068
7069 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
7070 Check sectors protect.
7071 @end deffn
7072
7073 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
7074 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
7075 @end deffn
7076
7077 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
7078 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
7079 @end deffn
7080
7081 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
7082 Configure external memory interface for boot.
7083 @end deffn
7084
7085 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
7086 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
7087 @end deffn
7088
7089 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
7090 Show information about flash driver.
7091 @end deffn
7092
7093 @end deffn
7094
7095 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
7096 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
7097 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
7098 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
7099 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
7100
7101 @example
7102 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7103 @end example
7104 @end deffn
7105
7106 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
7107 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
7108 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core. nRF52 family powered
7109 by ARM Cortex-M4 or M4F core is supported too. nRF52832 is fully supported
7110 including BPROT flash protection scheme. nRF52833 and nRF52840 devices are
7111 supported with the exception of security extensions (flash access control list
7112 - ACL).
7113
7114 @example
7115 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7116 @end example
7117
7118 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
7119
7120 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
7121 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
7122 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
7123 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
7124 code.
7125 @end deffn
7126
7127 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
7128 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
7129 @end deffn
7130
7131 @end deffn
7132
7133 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
7134 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
7135 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
7136
7137 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
7138 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
7139 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
7140 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
7141
7142 @example
7143 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7144 @end example
7145 @end deffn
7146
7147 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
7148 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
7149 and integrate flash memory.
7150
7151 @example
7152 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7153 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7154 @end example
7155
7156 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
7157 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
7158 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
7159 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
7160 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
7161 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
7162 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
7163 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
7164 @end deffn
7165 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
7166 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
7167 This will remove any Code Protection.
7168 @end deffn
7169 @end deffn
7170
7171 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
7172 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
7173 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
7174 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7175 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7176
7177 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
7178 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
7179
7180 @example
7181 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7182 @end example
7183
7184 psoc4-specific commands
7185 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
7186 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
7187
7188 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
7189 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
7190
7191 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
7192 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
7193 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
7194
7195 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7196 @end deffn
7197
7198 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
7199 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
7200
7201 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7202 @end deffn
7203 @end deffn
7204
7205 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
7206 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7207 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7208 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
7209 apart from the base address.
7210
7211 @example
7212 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7213 @end example
7214
7215 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
7216 @quotation Attention
7217 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
7218 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
7219 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
7220 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
7221 @end quotation
7222
7223 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
7224
7225 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
7226 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
7227 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
7228 @end deffn
7229 @end deffn
7230
7231 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
7232 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7233 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7234 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
7235 apart from the base address.
7236
7237 @example
7238 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
7239 $_TARGETNAME
7240 @end example
7241 @end deffn
7242
7243 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
7244 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7245 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7246 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
7247
7248 @example
7249 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7250 @end example
7251
7252 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
7253
7254 @itemize
7255 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
7256 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
7257 @end itemize
7258
7259 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
7260
7261 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
7262 @quotation Attention
7263 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
7264 after successful write.
7265 @end quotation
7266 @end deffn
7267
7268 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
7269 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
7270 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
7271 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
7272
7273 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
7274 @itemize @bullet
7275 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
7276 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
7277 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
7278 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
7279 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
7280 row size: 512 bytes.
7281 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
7282 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
7283 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
7284 operation will erase row automatically.
7285 @end itemize
7286
7287 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
7288 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
7289
7290 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
7291
7292 @example
7293 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7294 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7295 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7296 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7297 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7298 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7299 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7300 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7301 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7302 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7303 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7304 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7305
7306 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7307 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7308 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7309 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7310 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7311 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7312 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7313 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7314 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7315 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7316 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7317 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7318 @end example
7319
7320 psoc6-specific commands
7321 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7322 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7323 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7324 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7325 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7326 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7327 @end deffn
7328
7329 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7330 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7331 by @command{flash banks}.
7332 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7333 @end deffn
7334 @end deffn
7335
7336 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7337 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7338 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7339 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7340 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7341
7342 @example
7343 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7344 @end example
7345 @end deffn
7346
7347 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7348 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7349 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7350 and SWD interface.
7351 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7352 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7353
7354 @example
7355 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7356 @end example
7357
7358 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7359
7360 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7361 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7362 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7363 @end deffn
7364
7365 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7366 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7367 @end deffn
7368 @end deffn
7369
7370 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7371 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7372 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7373 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7374 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7375
7376 @example
7377 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7378 @end example
7379
7380 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7381 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7382 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7383 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7384 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7385 disabled.
7386
7387 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7388 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7389 @quotation Warning
7390 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7391 applied to all of them.
7392 @end quotation
7393 @end deffn
7394 @end deffn
7395
7396 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7397 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7398 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7399 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7400 The driver also works with GD32VF103 powered by RISC-V core.
7401 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7402 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7403
7404 @example
7405 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7406 @end example
7407
7408 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7409 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7410 the flash driver.
7411
7412 @example
7413 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7414 @end example
7415
7416 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7417 as per the following example.
7418 @example
7419 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7420 @end example
7421
7422 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7423
7424 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7425 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7426 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7427 @end deffn
7428
7429 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7430 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7431 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7432 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7433 @end deffn
7434
7435 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7436 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7437 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7438 @end deffn
7439
7440 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7441 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7442 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7443 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7444 @end deffn
7445
7446 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7447 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7448 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7449 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7450 @end deffn
7451
7452 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7453 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7454 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7455 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7456 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7457 @end deffn
7458 @end deffn
7459
7460 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7461 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7462 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7463 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7464 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7465
7466 @example
7467 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7468 @end example
7469
7470 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7471 as per the following example.
7472 @example
7473 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7474 @end example
7475
7476 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7477 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7478 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7479 @end deffn
7480
7481 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7482 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7483 the flash driver.
7484
7485 @example
7486 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7487 @end example
7488
7489 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7490
7491 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7492 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7493 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7494 @end deffn
7495
7496 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7497 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7498 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7499 @end deffn
7500
7501 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7502 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7503 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7504 @end deffn
7505
7506 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7507 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7508 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7509 @end deffn
7510
7511 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7512 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7513 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7514 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7515 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7516 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7517 @end deffn
7518
7519 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7520 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7521 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7522 @end deffn
7523 @end deffn
7524
7525 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7526 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7527 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7528 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7529 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7530
7531 @example
7532 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7533 @end example
7534
7535 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7536 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7537 the flash driver.
7538
7539 @example
7540 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7541 @end example
7542
7543 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7544
7545 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7546 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7547 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7548 @end deffn
7549
7550 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7551 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7552 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7553 @end deffn
7554
7555 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7556 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7557 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7558 @end deffn
7559
7560 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7561 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7562 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7563 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7564 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7565
7566 Example usage:
7567 @example
7568 # read OPTSR_CUR
7569 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7570 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7571 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7572 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7573 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7574 @end example
7575 @end deffn
7576
7577 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7578 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7579 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7580 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7581 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7582 will be touched).
7583
7584 Example usage:
7585 @example
7586 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7587 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7588 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7589 @end example
7590 @end deffn
7591 @end deffn
7592
7593 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7594 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7595 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7596 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7597 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7598
7599 @example
7600 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7601 @end example
7602
7603 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7604 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7605 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7606 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7607 second bank.
7608
7609 @example
7610 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7611 @end example
7612
7613 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7614
7615 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7616 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7617 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7618 @end deffn
7619
7620 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7621 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7622 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7623 @end deffn
7624
7625 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7626 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7627 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7628 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7629 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7630 @end deffn
7631 @end deffn
7632
7633 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7634 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7635 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7636 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7637 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7638 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7639
7640 @example
7641 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7642 @end example
7643
7644 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7645 as per the following example.
7646 @example
7647 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7648 @end example
7649
7650 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7651 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7652 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7653 @end deffn
7654
7655 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7656 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7657 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7658 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7659
7660 @example
7661 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7662 @end example
7663
7664 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7665
7666 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7667 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7668 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7669
7670 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7671 @end deffn
7672
7673 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7674 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7675 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7676
7677 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7678 @end deffn
7679
7680 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7681 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7682 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7683 @end deffn
7684
7685 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7686 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7687 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7688 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7689
7690 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7691 @example
7692 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7693 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7694 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7695 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7696 @end example
7697
7698 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7699 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7700 @end deffn
7701
7702 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7703 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7704 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7705 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7706 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7707
7708 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7709
7710 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7711 @example
7712 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7713 @end example
7714
7715 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7716 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7717 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7718 @end deffn
7719
7720 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7721 List the protected areas using WRP.
7722 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7723 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7724 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7725
7726 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7727 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7728 in single or dual-banks mode.
7729 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7730 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7731
7732 @end deffn
7733
7734 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7735 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7736 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7737 @end deffn
7738
7739 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
7740 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
7741 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
7742 the TrustZone status.
7743 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
7744 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
7745 @end deffn
7746 @end deffn
7747
7748 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7749 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7750 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7751 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7752 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7753
7754 @example
7755 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7756 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7757 @end example
7758
7759 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7760 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7761 for the specified flash bank.
7762 @end deffn
7763 @end deffn
7764
7765 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7766 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7767 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7768 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7769 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7770
7771 @example
7772 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7773 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7774 @end example
7775
7776 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7777 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7778 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7779
7780 @itemize @bullet
7781 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7782 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7783 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7784 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7785 @end itemize
7786 @end deffn
7787
7788 @end deffn
7789
7790 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7791 @cindex str9xpec
7792
7793 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7794 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7795 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7796 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7797
7798 Here is some background info to help
7799 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7800 the str9:
7801 @enumerate
7802 @item
7803 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7804 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7805 @item
7806 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7807 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7808 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7809 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7810 @end enumerate
7811
7812 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7813 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7814 configured for flash bank 0.
7815 @example
7816 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7817 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7818 adapter assert srst
7819 # turn off target polling
7820 poll off
7821 # disable str9 core
7822 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7823 # read option bytes
7824 str9xpec options_read 0
7825 # re-enable str9 core
7826 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7827 poll on
7828 reset halt
7829 @end example
7830 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7831 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7832 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7833 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7834
7835 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7836
7837 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7838 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7839 @end deffn
7840
7841 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7842 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7843 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7844 @end deffn
7845
7846 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7847 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7848 erase the device.
7849 @end deffn
7850
7851 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7852 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7853 @end deffn
7854
7855 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7856 Configure str9 boot bank.
7857 @end deffn
7858
7859 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7860 Configure str9 lvd source.
7861 @end deffn
7862
7863 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7864 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7865 @end deffn
7866
7867 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7868 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7869 @end deffn
7870
7871 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7872 Read str9 option bytes.
7873 @end deffn
7874
7875 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7876 Write str9 option bytes.
7877 @end deffn
7878
7879 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7880 unlock str9 device.
7881 @end deffn
7882
7883 @end deffn
7884
7885 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7886 @cindex swm050
7887 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7888
7889 @example
7890 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7891 @end example
7892
7893 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7894
7895 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7896 Erases the entire flash bank.
7897 @end deffn
7898
7899 @end deffn
7900
7901
7902 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7903 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7904 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7905 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7906
7907 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7908
7909 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7910 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7911 @end deffn
7912
7913 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
7914 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7915 @end deffn
7916
7917 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7918 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7919 the flash clock.
7920 @end deffn
7921 @end deffn
7922
7923 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
7924 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7925 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7926 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7927 correct bank config.
7928
7929 @example
7930 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7931 @end example
7932 @end deffn
7933
7934 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
7935 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7936 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7937 @end deffn
7938
7939 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
7940 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7941 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7942
7943 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7944
7945 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7946 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7947 @end deffn
7948
7949 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7950 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7951 @end deffn
7952
7953 @end deffn
7954
7955 @section NAND Flash Commands
7956 @cindex NAND
7957
7958 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7959 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7960 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7961
7962 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7963 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7964 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7965 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7966 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7967 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7968
7969 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7970 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7971 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7972 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7973 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7974 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7975 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7976 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7977 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7978 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7979
7980 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7981 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7982 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7983 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7984 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7985 every 512 bytes of data.
7986
7987 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7988 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7989 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7990 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7991 ECC mode is used.
7992
7993 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7994 @enumerate
7995 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7996 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7997 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7998 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7999 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
8000 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
8001 to access that device.
8002 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
8003 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
8004 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
8005 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
8006 de-brick a board.
8007 @end enumerate
8008
8009 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
8010 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
8011 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
8012 are only 32 bits wide.
8013 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
8014 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
8015 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
8016 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
8017
8018 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
8019 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
8020 @cindex NAND configuration
8021
8022 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
8023 plus some additional configuration that's done after
8024 OpenOCD has initialized.
8025
8026 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
8027 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
8028 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
8029 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
8030 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
8031 they were a single (larger) device.
8032 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
8033 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
8034
8035 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
8036 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
8037 configuration files, not interactively.
8038
8039 @itemize @bullet
8040 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
8041 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
8042 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
8043 associated with the NAND device being declared.
8044 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
8045 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
8046 commands to the NAND controller.
8047 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
8048 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
8049 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
8050 for more information.
8051 @end itemize
8052 @end deffn
8053
8054 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
8055 Prints a summary of each device declared
8056 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
8057 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
8058 @example
8059 > nand list
8060 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
8061 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
8062 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
8063 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
8064 >
8065 @end example
8066 @end deffn
8067
8068 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
8069 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
8070 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
8071 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8072 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
8073 it with most other NAND commands.
8074 @end deffn
8075
8076 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
8077
8078 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
8079 @cindex NAND reading
8080 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
8081 starting at the specified offset.
8082 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8083
8084 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8085 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8086
8087 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
8088 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
8089 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
8090
8091 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
8092 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
8093 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
8094 method which handled that error correction.
8095
8096 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
8097 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
8098 @itemize @bullet
8099 @item no oob_* parameter
8100 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
8101 @item @code{oob_raw}
8102 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
8103 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
8104 spare areas associated with each data page.
8105 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
8106 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
8107 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
8108 @item @code{oob_only}
8109 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
8110 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
8111 spare areas associated with each data page.
8112 @end itemize
8113 @end deffn
8114
8115 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
8116 @cindex NAND erasing
8117 @cindex NAND programming
8118 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
8119 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
8120 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
8121 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
8122 If those parameters are not specified,
8123 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
8124 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8125
8126 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
8127 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
8128 block marker.
8129 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
8130 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
8131 @end deffn
8132
8133 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
8134 @cindex NAND writing
8135 @cindex NAND programming
8136 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
8137 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
8138 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
8139 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8140
8141 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8142 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8143
8144 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
8145 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
8146 past the end of the device.
8147 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
8148 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
8149 if that's being written.)
8150
8151 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
8152 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
8153 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
8154
8155 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
8156 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
8157 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
8158 @itemize @bullet
8159 @item no oob_* parameter
8160 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8161 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
8162 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
8163 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
8164 with hardware-computed ECC data.
8165 @item @code{oob_only}
8166 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
8167 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
8168 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
8169 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
8170 @item @code{oob_raw}
8171 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
8172 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
8173 un-altered OOB.
8174 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
8175 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
8176 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
8177 @item @code{oob_softecc}
8178 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8179 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
8180 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
8181 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
8182 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
8183 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
8184 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8185 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
8186 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
8187 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
8188 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
8189 @end itemize
8190 @end deffn
8191
8192 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
8193 @cindex NAND verification
8194 @cindex NAND programming
8195 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
8196 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
8197 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8198
8199 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8200 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8201
8202 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
8203 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
8204 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
8205 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
8206 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
8207
8208 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
8209 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
8210 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
8211
8212 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
8213 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
8214 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
8215 be removed in a future release.
8216 @end deffn
8217
8218 @subsection Other NAND commands
8219 @cindex NAND other commands
8220
8221 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
8222 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
8223 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
8224 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
8225 continues for @var{length} bytes.
8226 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
8227 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
8228 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8229
8230 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
8231 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
8232 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
8233 @end deffn
8234
8235 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
8236 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8237 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
8238 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
8239 status for each block.
8240 @end deffn
8241
8242 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8243 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
8244 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8245
8246 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
8247 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
8248 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
8249 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
8250 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
8251
8252 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
8253 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
8254 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
8255 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
8256 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
8257 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
8258 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
8259 @end deffn
8260
8261 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
8262 @subsection NAND Driver List
8263 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
8264 driver-specific options and behaviors.
8265 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
8266
8267 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
8268 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
8269 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
8270 address of the ECC controller.
8271 @example
8272 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
8273 @end example
8274 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
8275 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
8276 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
8277 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
8278 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
8279 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
8280 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
8281 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8282 @end deffn
8283 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
8284 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
8285 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8286 @end deffn
8287
8288 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
8289 properly configured for input or output.
8290 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
8291 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
8292 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8293 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8294 @end deffn
8295 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
8296 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
8297 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8298 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8299 @end deffn
8300 @end deffn
8301
8302 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
8303 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
8304 chips from Texas Instruments.
8305 It takes three extra parameters:
8306 address of the NAND chip;
8307 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8308 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8309 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8310 @example
8311 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8312 @end example
8313 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8314 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8315 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8316 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8317 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8318 @end deffn
8319
8320 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8321 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8322 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8323 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8324 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8325 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8326 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8327 @end deffn
8328
8329 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8330 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8331 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8332 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8333 @end deffn
8334 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8335
8336 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8337 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8338 should work for this chip as well.
8339 @end deffn
8340
8341 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8342 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8343 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8344 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8345 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8346 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8347 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8348 @example
8349 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8350 @end example
8351 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8352 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8353 without parameter query status.
8354 @end deffn
8355 @end deffn
8356
8357 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8358 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8359 parameter: the address of the controller.
8360 @example
8361 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8362 @end example
8363 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8364 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8365 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8366 change any behavior.
8367 @end deffn
8368
8369 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8370 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8371 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8372 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8373 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8374 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8375 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8376 specialized commands.
8377 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8378 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8379 change any behavior.
8380 @end deffn
8381
8382 @node Flash Programming
8383 @chapter Flash Programming
8384
8385 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8386 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8387 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8388
8389 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8390 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8391
8392 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8393 @enumerate
8394 @item 'init' is executed.
8395 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8396 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8397 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8398 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8399 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8400 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8401 @end enumerate
8402
8403 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8404
8405 @example
8406 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8407 # are optional parameters
8408 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8409 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8410
8411 # binary files need the flash address passing
8412 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8413 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8414 @end example
8415
8416 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8417 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8418 @cindex PLD
8419 @cindex FPGA
8420
8421 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8422 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8423 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8424 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8425 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8426 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8427 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8428
8429 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8430
8431 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8432 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8433 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8434
8435 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
8436 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
8437
8438 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
8439 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8440 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
8441 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
8442 behavior.
8443 @end deffn
8444
8445 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8446 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
8447 @end deffn
8448
8449 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
8450 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
8451 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8452 @end deffn
8453
8454 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8455
8456 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8457 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8458 that particular type of PLD.
8459
8460 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
8461 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8462 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8463
8464 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8465 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8466 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8467
8468 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8469 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8470 for FPGA @var{num}.
8471 @end deffn
8472 @end deffn
8473
8474 @node General Commands
8475 @chapter General Commands
8476 @cindex commands
8477
8478 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8479 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8480 commands are documented elsewhere.
8481
8482 Intent:
8483 @itemize @bullet
8484 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8485 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8486 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8487 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8488
8489 @item @b{From the human}
8490 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8491 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8492
8493 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8494 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8495 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8496
8497 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8498 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8499 port is 5555.
8500 @end itemize
8501
8502
8503 @section Server Commands
8504
8505 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8506 Exits the current telnet session.
8507 @end deffn
8508
8509 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8510 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8511 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8512 Not every command provides helptext.
8513
8514 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8515 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8516 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8517 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8518 @end deffn
8519
8520 @deffn {Command} {usage} [string]
8521 With no parameters, prints usage text for all commands. Otherwise,
8522 prints all usage text of which command, help text, and usage text
8523 containing @var{string}.
8524 Not every command provides helptext.
8525 @end deffn
8526
8527 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8528 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8529 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8530 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8531 Useful in connection with script files
8532 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8533 @end deffn
8534
8535 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8536 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8537 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8538 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8539
8540 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, the command @command{shutdown}
8541 will be automatically executed to cause OpenOCD to exit.
8542
8543 It is possible to specify, in the TCL list @var{pre_shutdown_commands} , a
8544 set of commands to be automatically executed before @command{shutdown} , e.g.:
8545 @example
8546 lappend pre_shutdown_commands @{echo "Goodbye, my friend ..."@}
8547 lappend pre_shutdown_commands @{echo "see you soon !"@}
8548 @end example
8549 The commands in the list will be executed (in the same order they occupy
8550 in the list) before OpenOCD exits. If one of the commands in the list
8551 fails, then the remaining commands are not executed anymore while OpenOCD
8552 will proceed to quit.
8553 @end deffn
8554
8555 @anchor{debuglevel}
8556 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8557 @cindex message level
8558 Display debug level.
8559 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8560 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8561 Level 0 is error messages only;
8562 level 1 adds warnings;
8563 level 2 adds informational messages;
8564 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8565 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8566 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8567 the command line along with the location of that log
8568 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8569 @xref{Running}.
8570 @end deffn
8571
8572 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8573 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8574 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8575 @example
8576 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8577 @end example
8578 @end deffn
8579
8580 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8581 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8582 the default log output channel is stderr.
8583 @end deffn
8584
8585 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8586 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8587 @end deffn
8588
8589 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8590 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8591 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8592 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8593 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8594 @end deffn
8595
8596 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8597 @section Target State handling
8598 @cindex reset
8599 @cindex halt
8600 @cindex target initialization
8601
8602 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8603 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8604 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8605 a current target which is used to perform the
8606 various operations. The current target may be changed
8607 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8608 target which should become current.
8609
8610 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8611 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8612 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8613 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8614 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8615
8616 @emph{With no arguments}:
8617 list all available registers for the current target,
8618 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8619 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8620 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8621 are flagged as such.
8622
8623 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8624 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8625 bypassing any internal cache.
8626
8627 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8628 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8629 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8630 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8631 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8632 relevant module will flush such values.
8633
8634 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8635 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8636
8637 @example
8638 > reg
8639 ===== ARM registers
8640 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8641 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8642 (2) r2 (/32)
8643 ...
8644 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8645 >
8646 @end example
8647 @end deffn
8648
8649 @deffn {Command} {set_reg} dict
8650 Set register values of the target.
8651
8652 @itemize
8653 @item @var{dict} ... Tcl dictionary with pairs of register names and values.
8654 @end itemize
8655
8656 For example, the following command sets the value 0 to the program counter (pc)
8657 register and 0x1000 to the stack pointer (sp) register:
8658
8659 @example
8660 set_reg @{pc 0 sp 0x1000@}
8661 @end example
8662 @end deffn
8663
8664 @deffn {Command} {get_reg} [-force] list
8665 Get register values from the target and return them as Tcl dictionary with pairs
8666 of register names and values.
8667 If option "-force" is set, the register values are read directly from the
8668 target, bypassing any caching.
8669
8670 @itemize
8671 @item @var{list} ... List of register names
8672 @end itemize
8673
8674 For example, the following command retrieves the values from the program
8675 counter (pc) and stack pointer (sp) register:
8676
8677 @example
8678 get_reg @{pc sp@}
8679 @end example
8680 @end deffn
8681
8682 @deffn {Command} {write_memory} address width data ['phys']
8683 This function provides an efficient way to write to the target memory from a Tcl
8684 script.
8685
8686 @itemize
8687 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
8688 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
8689 @item @var{data} ... Tcl list with the elements to write
8690 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
8691 @end itemize
8692
8693 For example, the following command writes two 32 bit words into the target
8694 memory at address 0x20000000:
8695
8696 @example
8697 write_memory 0x20000000 32 @{0xdeadbeef 0x00230500@}
8698 @end example
8699 @end deffn
8700
8701 @deffn {Command} {read_memory} address width count ['phys']
8702 This function provides an efficient way to read the target memory from a Tcl
8703 script.
8704 A Tcl list containing the requested memory elements is returned by this function.
8705
8706 @itemize
8707 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
8708 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
8709 @item @var{count} ... number of elements to read
8710 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
8711 @end itemize
8712
8713 For example, the following command reads two 32 bit words from the target
8714 memory at address 0x20000000:
8715
8716 @example
8717 read_memory 0x20000000 32 2
8718 @end example
8719 @end deffn
8720
8721 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8722 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8723 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8724 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8725 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8726 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8727 (and enter debug mode).
8728 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8729
8730 @quotation Warning
8731 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8732 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8733 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8734 power mode by gating the core clock;
8735 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8736
8737 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8738 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8739 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8740 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8741 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8742 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8743
8744 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8745 work with a JTAG debugger.
8746 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8747 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8748 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8749 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8750 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8751 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8752 @end quotation
8753
8754 @end deffn
8755
8756 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8757 Resume the target at its current code position,
8758 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8759 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8760 @end deffn
8761
8762 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8763 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8764 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8765 @end deffn
8766
8767 @anchor{resetcommand}
8768 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8769 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8770 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8771 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8772 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8773 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8774 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8775
8776 The optional parameter specifies what should
8777 happen after the reset.
8778 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8779 The other options will not work on all systems.
8780 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8781
8782 @itemize @minus
8783 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8784 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8785 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8786 @end itemize
8787 @end deffn
8788
8789 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8790 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8791 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8792 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8793 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8794 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8795 state.
8796 @end deffn
8797
8798 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8799 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8800 Set values of reset signals.
8801 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8802 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8803 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8804 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8805
8806 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8807 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8808 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8809 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8810 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8811 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8812 the signal will not be modified.
8813
8814 @quotation Note
8815 TRST is specially handled.
8816 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8817 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8818 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8819 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8820 instead of the TRST signal.
8821 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8822 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8823 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8824 with handlers for that event.
8825 @end quotation
8826 @end deffn
8827
8828 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8829 @section Memory access commands
8830 @cindex memory access
8831
8832 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8833 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8834 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8835 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8836
8837 @enumerate
8838 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8839 to change the current target.
8840 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8841 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8842 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8843 @end enumerate
8844
8845 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8846 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8847 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8848 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8849 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8850 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8851 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8852 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8853 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8854 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8855 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8856 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8857 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8858 (If you want to process the data instead of displaying it,
8859 see the @code{read_memory} primitives.)
8860 @end deffn
8861
8862 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8863 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8864 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8865 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8866 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8867 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8868 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8869 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8870 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8871 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8872 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8873 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8874 @end deffn
8875
8876 @anchor{imageaccess}
8877 @section Image loading commands
8878 @cindex image loading
8879 @cindex image dumping
8880
8881 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8882 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8883 binary file named @var{filename}.
8884 @end deffn
8885
8886 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8887 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8888 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8889 @end deffn
8890
8891 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8892 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8893 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8894 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8895 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8896 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8897 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8898 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8899 separately.
8900 @end deffn
8901
8902 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8903 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8904 The file format may optionally be specified
8905 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8906 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8907 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8908 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8909 @example
8910 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8911 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8912 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8913 load_image $fname [expr @{$address - $foffset@}] bin \
8914 $address $length
8915 @}
8916 @end example
8917 @end deffn
8918
8919 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8920 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8921 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8922 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8923 The file format may optionally be specified
8924 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8925 @end deffn
8926
8927 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8928 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8929 The file format may optionally be specified
8930 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8931 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8932 @end deffn
8933
8934 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8935 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8936 The file format may optionally be specified
8937 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8938 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8939 @end deffn
8940
8941
8942 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8943 @cindex breakpoint
8944 @cindex watchpoint
8945
8946 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8947 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8948 watchpoints.
8949 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8950
8951 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8952 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8953 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8954 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8955 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8956 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8957
8958 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8959 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8960 @end deffn
8961
8962 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
8963 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8964 @end deffn
8965
8966 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
8967 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8968 @end deffn
8969
8970 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8971 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8972 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8973 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8974 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8975 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8976 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8977 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8978 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8979 @end deffn
8980
8981
8982 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8983
8984 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8985 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8986 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8987 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8988 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8989 running, can be used.
8990 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8991 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8992 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8993
8994 @quotation Note
8995 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8996 @end quotation
8997
8998 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8999 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
9000 communication, respectively.
9001
9002 @quotation Note
9003 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
9004 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
9005 example.
9006 @end quotation
9007
9008 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
9009 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
9010 of TCP/IP connections.
9011
9012 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
9013 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
9014 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
9015 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
9016 @var{size} bytes.
9017 @end deffn
9018
9019 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
9020 Start RTT.
9021 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
9022 @end deffn
9023
9024 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
9025 Stop RTT.
9026 @end deffn
9027
9028 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
9029 Display the polling interval.
9030 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
9031 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
9032 checked for new data.
9033 @end deffn
9034
9035 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
9036 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
9037 @end deffn
9038
9039 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
9040 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
9041 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
9042 @end deffn
9043
9044 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
9045 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
9046 @end deffn
9047
9048 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
9049 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
9050 @end deffn
9051
9052 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
9053 on the target device.
9054
9055 @example
9056 resume
9057
9058 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
9059 rtt start
9060
9061 rtt server start 9090 0
9062 @end example
9063
9064 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
9065 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
9066 TCP/IP port 9090.
9067
9068
9069 @section Misc Commands
9070
9071 @cindex profiling
9072 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
9073 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
9074 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
9075 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
9076 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
9077 limit the address range.
9078 @end deffn
9079
9080 @deffn {Command} {version}
9081 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
9082 @end deffn
9083
9084 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
9085 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
9086 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
9087 @end deffn
9088
9089 @deffn {Command} {add_help_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
9090 Add or replace help text on the given @var{command_name}.
9091 @end deffn
9092
9093 @deffn {Command} {add_usage_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
9094 Add or replace usage text on the given @var{command_name}.
9095 @end deffn
9096
9097 @node Architecture and Core Commands
9098 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
9099 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
9100 @cindex Core Specific Commands
9101
9102 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
9103 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
9104 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
9105 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
9106
9107 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
9108 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
9109 @cindex tracing
9110 @cindex ETM
9111 @cindex ETB
9112
9113 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
9114 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
9115 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
9116
9117 @itemize
9118 @item
9119 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
9120 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
9121 supports such an interface.
9122 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
9123 and trace port support.)
9124 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
9125 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
9126 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
9127 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
9128 in the board-specific configuration file.
9129 @item
9130 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
9131 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
9132 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
9133 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
9134 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
9135 @end itemize
9136
9137 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
9138
9139 @quotation Issues
9140 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
9141 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
9142
9143 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
9144 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
9145 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
9146 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
9147 dummy trace port driver}.
9148
9149 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
9150 as well as tracing only during specific states
9151 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
9152
9153 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
9154 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
9155 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
9156 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
9157 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
9158
9159 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
9160 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
9161 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
9162 this original style of JTAG access.
9163 @end quotation
9164
9165 @subsection ETM Configuration
9166 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
9167
9168 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
9169 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
9170 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
9171
9172 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
9173 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
9174 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
9175 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
9176 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
9177 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
9178 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
9179 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
9180 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
9181
9182 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
9183 or @option{demultiplexed}.
9184 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
9185
9186 @quotation Warning
9187 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
9188 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
9189 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
9190 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
9191 @end quotation
9192
9193 @quotation Note
9194 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
9195 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
9196 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
9197 what CPU activities are traced.
9198 @end quotation
9199 @end deffn
9200
9201 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
9202 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
9203 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
9204 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
9205 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
9206 @end deffn
9207
9208 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
9209 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
9210 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
9211 Did trace data overflow?
9212 Was it triggered?
9213 @end deffn
9214
9215 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
9216 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
9217 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
9218 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
9219 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
9220
9221 @itemize
9222 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
9223 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
9224 The value is one of
9225 @option{none} (save nothing),
9226 @option{data} (save data),
9227 @option{address} (save addresses),
9228 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
9229 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
9230 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
9231 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
9232 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
9233 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
9234 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
9235 trace stream without an image of the code.
9236 @end itemize
9237 @end deffn
9238
9239 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9240 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
9241 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
9242 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
9243 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
9244
9245 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
9246 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
9247 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
9248 @end deffn
9249
9250 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
9251
9252 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
9253 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
9254 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
9255
9256 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
9257 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
9258 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
9259 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
9260 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
9261 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
9262 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
9263
9264 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
9265
9266 @itemize
9267 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
9268 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
9269 for instruction access within that function's body.
9270 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
9271 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
9272 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
9273 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
9274 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
9275 combining one of the above models with a counter.
9276 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
9277 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
9278 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
9279 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
9280 @item @emph{... more}
9281 @end itemize
9282
9283 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
9284 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
9285
9286 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
9287 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
9288 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
9289 @end deffn
9290
9291 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
9292 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
9293 @end deffn
9294
9295 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
9296 Opens an image file.
9297 @end deffn
9298
9299 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
9300 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
9301 @end deffn
9302
9303 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
9304 Starts trace data collection.
9305 @end deffn
9306
9307 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
9308 Stops trace data collection.
9309 @end deffn
9310
9311 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
9312 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
9313
9314 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
9315
9316 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
9317 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
9318 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
9319 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
9320 any trace data collection.}
9321 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
9322 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
9323 @end deffn
9324 @end deffn
9325
9326 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
9327 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
9328 to use on-chip ETB memory.
9329 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
9330 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
9331 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
9332 @end deffn
9333 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
9334 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
9335 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
9336 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
9337 trace trigger becomes active.
9338
9339 @itemize
9340 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
9341 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
9342 afterwards.
9343 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
9344 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
9345 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
9346 what caused that event to happen.
9347 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
9348 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
9349 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
9350 how the event caused trouble.
9351 @end itemize
9352 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
9353 @end deffn
9354
9355 @end deffn
9356
9357 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
9358 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
9359 @cindex CTI
9360
9361 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
9362 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
9363 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
9364 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
9365 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
9366 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
9367
9368 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
9369 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
9370 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
9371 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
9372 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
9373 including additional configuration.
9374 @end deffn
9375
9376 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
9377 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
9378 @end deffn
9379
9380 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
9381 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
9382 @end deffn
9383
9384 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
9385 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9386 @end deffn
9387
9388 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
9389 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9390 @end deffn
9391
9392 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
9393 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9394 @end deffn
9395
9396 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9397 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9398 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9399 @end deffn
9400
9401 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9402 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9403 of the CTI.
9404 @end deffn
9405
9406 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9407 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9408 useful in TCL scripting.
9409 @end deffn
9410
9411 @section Generic ARM
9412 @cindex ARM
9413
9414 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9415 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9416 commands that may be available.
9417
9418 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9419 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9420 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9421 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9422 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9423 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9424 @end deffn
9425
9426 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9427 @cindex disassemble
9428 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9429 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9430 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9431 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9432 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9433 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9434 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9435
9436 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9437 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9438 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9439 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9440 with a handful of exceptions.
9441 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9442 @end deffn
9443
9444 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9445 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9446 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9447 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9448 and using the MCR instruction.
9449 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9450 an ARM register.)
9451 @end deffn
9452
9453 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9454 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9455 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9456 and the MRC instruction.
9457 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9458 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9459 an ARM register.)
9460 @end deffn
9461
9462 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9463 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9464 core mode if necessary.
9465 @end deffn
9466
9467 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9468 @cindex ARM semihosting
9469 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9470
9471 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9472 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9473 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9474 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9475 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9476 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9477 @end deffn
9478
9479 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_redirect} (@option{disable} | @option{tcp} <port>
9480 [@option{debug}|@option{stdio}|@option{all})
9481 @cindex ARM semihosting
9482 Redirect semihosting messages to a specified TCP port.
9483
9484 This command redirects debug (READC, WRITEC and WRITE0) and stdio (READ, WRITE)
9485 semihosting operations to the specified TCP port.
9486 The command allows to select which type of operations to redirect (debug, stdio, all (default)).
9487 Note: for stdio operations, only I/O from/to ':tt' file descriptors are redirected.
9488 @end deffn
9489
9490 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9491 @cindex ARM semihosting
9492 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9493
9494 @example
9495 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9496 @end example
9497
9498 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9499 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9500 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9501 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9502 @end deffn
9503
9504 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9505 @cindex ARM semihosting
9506 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9507 status.
9508
9509 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9510 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9511 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9512 debugger.
9513 @end deffn
9514
9515 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9516 @cindex ARM semihosting
9517 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9518
9519 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9520 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9521 the value returned by the target.
9522
9523 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9524 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9525 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9526 encountering a break.
9527
9528 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9529 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9530 to the debugger.
9531 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9532 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9533 request or equivalent").
9534
9535 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9536 this option (default: disabled).
9537 @end deffn
9538
9539 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_read_user_param}
9540 @cindex ARM semihosting
9541 Read parameter of the semihosting call from the target. Usable in
9542 semihosting-user-cmd-0x10* event handlers, returning a string.
9543
9544 When the target makes semihosting call with operation number from range 0x100-
9545 0x107, an optional string parameter can be passed to the server. This parameter
9546 is valid during the run of the event handlers and is accessible with this
9547 command.
9548 @end deffn
9549
9550 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9551 @cindex ARMv4
9552 @cindex ARMv5
9553
9554 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9555 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9556 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9557 variant.
9558
9559 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9560 @cindex ARM7
9561 @cindex ARM9
9562
9563 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9564 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9565 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9566 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9567
9568 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9569 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9570 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9571 instead of breakpoints.
9572 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9573
9574 This should be
9575 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9576 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9577 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9578 @end deffn
9579
9580 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9581 @cindex DCC
9582 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9583 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9584 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9585
9586 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9587 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9588 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9589 @end deffn
9590
9591 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9592 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9593 that don't check completion of the operation.
9594 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9595
9596 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9597 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9598 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9599 @end deffn
9600
9601 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9602 @cindex ARM9
9603
9604 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9605 integer processors.
9606 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9607
9608 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9609 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9610 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9611 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9612
9613 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9614 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9615 @cindex vector_catch
9616 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9617 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9618 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9619 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9620 to those hardware vectors.
9621
9622 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9623 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9624 vector catch hardware to intercept
9625 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9626 @option{none} of them,
9627 or a list with one or more of the following:
9628 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9629 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9630 @end deffn
9631
9632 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9633 @cindex ARM920T
9634
9635 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9636 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9637 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9638 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9639 and ARM9 commands.
9640
9641 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9642 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9643 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9644 @end deffn
9645
9646 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9647 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9648 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9649 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9650 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9651 (Not all registers can be written.)
9652 @end deffn
9653
9654 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9655 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9656 @end deffn
9657
9658 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9659 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9660 @end deffn
9661
9662 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9663 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9664
9665 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9666 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9667 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9668 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9669 and ARM9 commands.
9670
9671 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9672 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9673
9674 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9675 Print information about the caches found.
9676 @end deffn
9677
9678 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9679 @cindex ARM966E
9680
9681 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9682 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9683 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9684 and ARM9 commands.
9685
9686 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9687 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9688 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9689 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9690 ARM966E-S TRM.
9691 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9692 as required for BIST support.
9693 @end deffn
9694
9695 @subsection XScale specific commands
9696 @cindex XScale
9697
9698 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9699
9700 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9701 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9702 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9703 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9704 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9705 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9706 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9707
9708 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9709 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9710 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9711 the mini-IC.
9712
9713 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9714 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9715 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9716 code layout in memory:
9717 @example
9718 _vectors:
9719 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9720 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9721 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9722 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9723 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9724 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9725 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9726 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9727 .org 0x100
9728 .long real_reset_vector
9729 .long real_ui_handler
9730 .long real_swi_handler
9731 .long real_pf_abort
9732 .long real_data_abort
9733 .long 0 /* unused */
9734 .long real_irq_handler
9735 .long real_fiq_handler
9736 @end example
9737
9738 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9739 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9740 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9741 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9742 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9743 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9744 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9745 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9746 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9747 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9748 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9749 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9750 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9751 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9752 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9753 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9754 software.
9755
9756 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9757 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9758 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9759 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9760
9761 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9762 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9763 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9764 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9765 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9766 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9767 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9768 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9769 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9770
9771 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9772 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9773
9774 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9775 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9776 @end deffn
9777
9778 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9779 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9780 @end deffn
9781
9782 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9783 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9784 @end deffn
9785
9786 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9787 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9788 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9789 @end deffn
9790
9791 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9792 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9793 @end deffn
9794
9795 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9796 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9797 @end deffn
9798
9799 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9800 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9801 @end deffn
9802
9803 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9804 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9805 @end deffn
9806
9807 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9808 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9809 @end deffn
9810
9811 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9812 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9813 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9814 and modifying how it is emptied.
9815 @end deffn
9816
9817 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9818 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9819 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9820 The image @var{type} may be one of
9821 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9822 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9823 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9824 @end deffn
9825
9826 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9827 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9828 @cindex vector_catch
9829 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9830 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9831
9832 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9833 @example
9834 0x01 Trap Reset
9835 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9836 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9837 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9838 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9839 0x20 reserved
9840 0x40 Trap IRQ
9841 0x80 Trap FIQ
9842 @end example
9843 @end deffn
9844
9845 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9846 @cindex vector_table
9847
9848 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9849 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9850 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9851 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9852 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9853
9854 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9855
9856 @end deffn
9857
9858 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9859 @cindex ARMv6
9860
9861 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9862 @cindex ARM11
9863
9864 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9865 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9866 which is enabled by default.
9867 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9868 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9869 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9870 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9871 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9872 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9873 @end deffn
9874
9875 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9876 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9877 which is enabled by default.
9878 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9879 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9880 @end deffn
9881
9882 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9883 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9884 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9885 they are disabled by default.
9886 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9887 @end deffn
9888
9889 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9890 @cindex vector_catch
9891 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9892 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9893 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9894
9895 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9896 for certain hardware events.
9897 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9898 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9899 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9900 @end deffn
9901
9902 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9903 @cindex ARMv7
9904 @cindex ARMv8
9905
9906 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9907 @cindex Cortex-A
9908
9909 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9910 display information about target caches
9911 @end deffn
9912
9913 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9914 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9915 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9916 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9917 Defaults to 'off'.
9918 @end deffn
9919
9920 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9921 Initialize core debug
9922 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9923 @end deffn
9924
9925 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9926 Display/set the current SMP mode
9927 @end deffn
9928
9929 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9930 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9931 @end deffn
9932
9933 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9934 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9935 @end deffn
9936
9937 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9938 configure l2x cache
9939 @end deffn
9940
9941 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9942 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9943 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9944 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9945 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9946 @end deffn
9947
9948 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9949 @cindex Cortex-R
9950
9951 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
9952 Initialize core debug
9953 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9954 @end deffn
9955
9956 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9957 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9958 @end deffn
9959
9960
9961 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9962 @cindex tracing
9963 @cindex SWO
9964 @cindex SWV
9965 @cindex TPIU
9966
9967 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9968 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9969 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9970 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9971
9972 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9973 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9974 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9975 which causes quite some confusion.
9976 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9977 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9978
9979 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9980 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9981 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9982
9983 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
9984 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9985 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9986 @end deffn
9987
9988 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9989 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9990 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9991 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9992
9993 @itemize @bullet
9994 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9995 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9996 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9997 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9998
9999 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
10000 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
10001 @end itemize
10002 @end deffn
10003
10004 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
10005 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
10006 @end deffn
10007
10008 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
10009 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
10010 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
10011 at any time after the initialization, too.
10012 @end deffn
10013
10014 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
10015 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
10016 individually queried, to return its current value.
10017 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
10018 @end deffn
10019
10020 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
10021 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
10022 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
10023 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
10024
10025 @itemize @bullet
10026 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
10027 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
10028
10029 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
10030 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
10031
10032 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
10033 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
10034
10035 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
10036 protocol used for trace data:
10037 @itemize @minus
10038 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
10039 data bits (default);
10040 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
10041 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
10042 @end itemize
10043
10044 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
10045 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
10046 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
10047 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
10048 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
10049 of the TPIU.
10050
10051 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
10052 the destination of the trace data:
10053 @itemize @minus
10054 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
10055 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
10056 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
10057 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
10058 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
10059 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
10060 each connected client;
10061 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
10062 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
10063 either a regular file or a named pipe.
10064 @end itemize
10065
10066 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
10067 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
10068 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
10069 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
10070
10071 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
10072 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
10073 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
10074 maximum supported rate automatically.
10075
10076 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
10077 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
10078 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
10079
10080 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
10081 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
10082 default value is @var{0}.
10083 @end itemize
10084 @end deffn
10085
10086 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
10087 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
10088 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
10089 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
10090 data.
10091 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
10092 after the @command{init}.
10093 @end deffn
10094
10095 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
10096 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
10097 @end deffn
10098
10099
10100
10101 Example usage:
10102 @enumerate
10103 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
10104 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
10105 enough to:
10106 @example
10107 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
10108 ...
10109 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
10110 ...
10111 @end example
10112 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
10113 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
10114 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
10115 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
10116 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
10117 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
10118 @example
10119 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
10120 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
10121 @end example
10122 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
10123 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
10124 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
10125 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
10126 @example
10127 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
10128 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
10129 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
10130 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
10131 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
10132 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
10133 @end example
10134 @end enumerate
10135
10136 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
10137 @cindex tracing
10138 @cindex SWO
10139 @cindex SWV
10140 @cindex ITM
10141 @cindex ETM
10142
10143 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
10144 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
10145 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
10146 @end deffn
10147
10148 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
10149 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
10150 @end deffn
10151
10152 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
10153 @cindex Cortex-M
10154
10155 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
10156 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
10157
10158 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
10159 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
10160 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
10161 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
10162 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
10163 the step command leaves with the core running.
10164
10165 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
10166 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
10167 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
10168 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
10169
10170 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
10171 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
10172 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
10173 does.
10174
10175 Default is @option{auto}.
10176 @end deffn
10177
10178 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
10179 @cindex vector_catch
10180 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
10181 for certain hardware events.
10182
10183 Parameters request interception of
10184 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
10185 @option{none} of them,
10186 or one or more of the following:
10187 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
10188 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
10189 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
10190 @option{irq_err},
10191 @option{state_err},
10192 @option{chk_err}, or
10193 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
10194 @option{reset}.
10195 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
10196 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
10197 are mapped to HardFault.
10198 UsageFault checks for
10199 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
10200 must also be explicitly enabled.
10201
10202 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
10203 @end deffn
10204
10205 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
10206 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
10207 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
10208
10209 @itemize @minus
10210 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
10211 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
10212 @end itemize
10213
10214 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
10215 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
10216 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
10217 to manually reset the peripherals.
10218 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10219
10220 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
10221 instead.
10222 @end deffn
10223
10224 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
10225 @cindex ARMv8-A
10226 @cindex aarch64
10227
10228 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
10229 Display information about target caches
10230 @end deffn
10231
10232 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
10233 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
10234 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
10235 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
10236 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
10237 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
10238 @end deffn
10239
10240 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
10241 @cindex disassemble
10242 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
10243 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
10244 @end deffn
10245
10246 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
10247 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
10248 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
10249 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
10250 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
10251 @end deffn
10252
10253 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10254 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
10255 @option{on}.
10256 @end deffn
10257
10258 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
10259 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
10260 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
10261 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
10262 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
10263 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
10264 @end deffn
10265
10266 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
10267
10268 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
10269 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
10270
10271 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
10272
10273 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
10274 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
10275 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
10276 @end deffn
10277
10278 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
10279 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
10280 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
10281 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
10282 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
10283 @end deffn
10284
10285 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
10286
10287 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
10288 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
10289 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
10290 @end deffn
10291
10292 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
10293
10294 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
10295 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
10296 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
10297 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
10298 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
10299 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
10300 can be collected.
10301
10302 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
10303 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
10304 tooling.
10305
10306 @quotation Issues
10307 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
10308 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
10309 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
10310 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
10311
10312 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
10313 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
10314 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
10315 software operation on the CPU.
10316 @end quotation
10317
10318 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
10319 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
10320 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
10321 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
10322 @end deffn
10323
10324 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
10325 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
10326 @end deffn
10327
10328 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10329 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
10330 control is disabled.
10331 @end deffn
10332
10333 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
10334 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
10335 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
10336 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
10337
10338 Supported trace formats:
10339 @itemize
10340 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
10341 timing to be determined.
10342 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
10343 addresses.
10344 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
10345 @end itemize
10346 @end deffn
10347
10348 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
10349 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
10350 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
10351 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10352
10353 Supported conditions:
10354 @itemize
10355 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
10356 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
10357 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
10358 instruction matches start data and mask.
10359 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
10360 instruction matches start data and mask.
10361 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
10362 data and mask.
10363 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10364 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10365 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10366 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
10367 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
10368 @end itemize
10369 @end deffn
10370
10371 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
10372 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
10373 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
10374 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10375
10376 Supported conditions:
10377 @itemize
10378 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
10379 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
10380 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
10381 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10382 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
10383 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10384 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
10385 data and mask.
10386 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10387 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10388 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10389 @end itemize
10390 @end deffn
10391
10392 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
10393 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
10394
10395 Supported triggers:
10396 @itemize
10397 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
10398 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
10399 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
10400 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
10401 collection.
10402 @end itemize
10403 @end deffn
10404
10405 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
10406
10407 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
10408 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
10409 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
10410 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
10411 @end deffn
10412
10413 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
10414 Display trace configuration.
10415 @end deffn
10416
10417 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10418 Display trace collection status.
10419 @end deffn
10420
10421 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10422 Start manual trace collection.
10423 @end deffn
10424
10425 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10426 Stop manual trace collection.
10427 @end deffn
10428
10429 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10430 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10431 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10432 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10433 @option{size} options using DMA.
10434 @end deffn
10435
10436 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10437 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10438 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10439 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10440 @option{size} options using DMA.
10441 @end deffn
10442
10443 @section Intel Architecture
10444
10445 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10446 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10447 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10448 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10449 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10450 @itemize
10451 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10452 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10453 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10454 @end itemize
10455
10456 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10457 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10458 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10459
10460 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10461 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10462 @end deffn
10463
10464 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10465 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10466 @end deffn
10467
10468 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10469 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10470 @end deffn
10471
10472 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10473 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10474 @end deffn
10475
10476 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10477 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10478 @end deffn
10479
10480 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10481 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10482 @end deffn
10483
10484 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10485
10486 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10487 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10488
10489 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10490 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10491 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10492 @end deffn
10493 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10494 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10495
10496 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10497
10498 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10499 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10500 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10501 @end deffn
10502
10503 @subsection Registers commands
10504 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10505 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10506 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10507
10508 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10509
10510 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10511 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10512 and "timer" groups.
10513
10514 @emph{example:}
10515 @example
10516 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10517 @end example
10518
10519 @end deffn
10520
10521 @section RISC-V Architecture
10522
10523 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10524 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10525 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10526 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10527 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10528 implement version 0.11.
10529
10530 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10531
10532 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10533 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10534 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10535
10536 @subsection Vector Registers
10537
10538 For harts that implement the vector extension, OpenOCD provides access to the
10539 relevant CSRs, as well as the vector registers (v0-v31). The size of each
10540 vector register is dependent on the value of vlenb. RISC-V allows each vector
10541 register to be divided into selected-width elements, and this division can be
10542 changed at run-time. Because OpenOCD cannot update register definitions at
10543 run-time, it exposes each vector register to gdb as a union of fields of
10544 vectors so that users can easily access individual bytes, shorts, words,
10545 longs, and quads inside each vector register. It is left to gdb or
10546 higher-level debuggers to present this data in a more intuitive format.
10547
10548 In the XML register description, the vector registers (when vlenb=16) look as
10549 follows:
10550
10551 @example
10552 <feature name="org.gnu.gdb.riscv.vector">
10553 <vector id="bytes" type="uint8" count="16"/>
10554 <vector id="shorts" type="uint16" count="8"/>
10555 <vector id="words" type="uint32" count="4"/>
10556 <vector id="longs" type="uint64" count="2"/>
10557 <vector id="quads" type="uint128" count="1"/>
10558 <union id="riscv_vector">
10559 <field name="b" type="bytes"/>
10560 <field name="s" type="shorts"/>
10561 <field name="w" type="words"/>
10562 <field name="l" type="longs"/>
10563 <field name="q" type="quads"/>
10564 </union>
10565 <reg name="v0" bitsize="128" regnum="4162" save-restore="no"
10566 type="riscv_vector" group="vector"/>
10567 ...
10568 <reg name="v31" bitsize="128" regnum="4193" save-restore="no"
10569 type="riscv_vector" group="vector"/>
10570 </feature>
10571 @end example
10572
10573 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10574
10575 @deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n[-m|=name] [...]
10576 Configure which CSRs to expose in addition to the standard ones. The CSRs to expose
10577 can be specified as individual register numbers or register ranges (inclusive). For the
10578 individually listed CSRs, a human-readable name can optionally be set using the @code{n=name}
10579 syntax, which will get @code{csr_} prepended to it. If no name is provided, the register will be
10580 named @code{csr<n>}.
10581
10582 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10583 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10584 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or if the target implements custom
10585 CSRs.
10586
10587 @example
10588 # Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 128 under the name "csr128":
10589 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128
10590
10591 # Expose multiple RISC-V CSRs 128..132 under names "csr128" through "csr132":
10592 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128-132
10593
10594 # Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 1996 under custom name "csr_myregister":
10595 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 1996=myregister
10596 @end example
10597 @end deffn
10598
10599 @deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_custom} n[-m|=name] [...]
10600 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10601 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10602 configures individual registers or register ranges (inclusive) that shall be exposed.
10603 Number 0 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10604 For individually listed registers, a human-readable name can be optionally provided
10605 using the @code{n=name} syntax, which will get @code{custom_} prepended to it. If no
10606 name is provided, the register will be named @code{custom<n>}.
10607
10608 @example
10609 # Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc010 (0xc000 + 16)
10610 # under the name "custom16":
10611 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16
10612
10613 # Expose a range of RISC-V custom registers with numbers 0xc010 .. 0xc018
10614 # (0xc000+16 .. 0xc000+24) under the names "custom16" through "custom24":
10615 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16-24
10616
10617 # Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc020 (0xc000 + 32) under
10618 # user-defined name "custom_myregister":
10619 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 32=myregister
10620 @end example
10621 @end deffn
10622
10623 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10624 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10625 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10626 @end deffn
10627
10628 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10629 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10630 deasserted.
10631 @end deffn
10632
10633 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
10634 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
10635 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
10636 @end deffn
10637
10638 @deffn Command {riscv set_mem_access} method1 [method2] [method3]
10639 Specify which RISC-V memory access method(s) shall be used, and in which order
10640 of priority. At least one method must be specified.
10641
10642 Available methods are:
10643 @itemize
10644 @item @code{progbuf} - Use RISC-V Debug Program Buffer to access memory.
10645 @item @code{sysbus} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug System Bus interface.
10646 @item @code{abstract} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug abstract commands.
10647 @end itemize
10648
10649 By default, all memory access methods are enabled in the following order:
10650 @code{progbuf sysbus abstract}.
10651
10652 This command can be used to change the memory access methods if the default
10653 behavior is not suitable for a particular target.
10654 @end deffn
10655
10656 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10657 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10658 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10659 on physical memory.
10660 @end deffn
10661
10662 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10663 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10664 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10665 performed on physical memory.
10666 @end deffn
10667
10668 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10669 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10670 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10671 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10672 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10673 race condition problem in your code.
10674
10675 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10676 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10677 @end deffn
10678
10679 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10680 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10681 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10682 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10683 values.
10684
10685 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10686 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10687 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10688 @end deffn
10689
10690 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10691 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10692 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10693 @end deffn
10694
10695 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10696 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10697 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10698 @end deffn
10699
10700 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10701 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10702 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10703 @end deffn
10704
10705 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10706 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10707 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10708 @end deffn
10709
10710 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10711
10712 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10713 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10714 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10715 @example
10716 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10717 riscv authdata_write [expr @{$challenge + 1@}]
10718 @end example
10719
10720 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10721 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10722 @end deffn
10723
10724 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10725 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10726 @end deffn
10727
10728 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10729
10730 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10731 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10732
10733 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10734 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10735 @end deffn
10736
10737 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10738 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10739 @end deffn
10740
10741 @section ARC Architecture
10742 @cindex ARC
10743
10744 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10745 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10746 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10747 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10748 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10749 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10750 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10751 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10752 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10753 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10754 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10755 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10756 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10757 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10758 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10759
10760
10761 @subsection General ARC commands
10762
10763 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10764
10765 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10766 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10767 arguments:
10768
10769 @itemize @bullet
10770
10771 @item @code{-name} name
10772 @*Name of a register.
10773
10774 @item @code{-num} number
10775 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10776
10777 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10778 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10779
10780 @end itemize
10781
10782 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10783
10784 @itemize @bullet
10785
10786 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10787 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10788 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10789 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10790 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10791 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10792
10793 @item @code{-core}
10794 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10795 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10796 spaces.
10797
10798 @item @code{-bcr}
10799 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10800 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10801 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10802 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10803 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10804
10805 @item @code{-type} type_name
10806 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10807 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10808
10809 @item @code{-g}
10810 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10811 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10812 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10813 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10814 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10815
10816 @end itemize
10817
10818 @end deffn
10819
10820 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10821 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10822 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10823 @end deffn
10824
10825 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10826 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10827 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10828 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10829 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10830 startbit endbit}.
10831 @end deffn
10832
10833 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10834 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10835 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10836 @end deffn
10837
10838 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10839 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10840 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10841 @end deffn
10842
10843 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10844
10845 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10846 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10847 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10848 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10849
10850 @end deffn
10851
10852 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10853 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10854 registers.
10855 @end deffn
10856
10857 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10858 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10859 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10860 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10861
10862 @end deffn
10863
10864 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10865 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10866 registers.
10867 @end deffn
10868
10869 @section STM8 Architecture
10870 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10871 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10872
10873 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10874 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10875
10876 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10877 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10878 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10879 @cindex tracing
10880 @cindex libdcc
10881 @cindex DCC
10882 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10883 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10884 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10885 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10886
10887 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10888 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10889 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10890 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10891 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10892 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10893
10894 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10895 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10896 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10897 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10898 The target being debugged may
10899 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10900 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10901 each supported by a command:
10902
10903 @itemize
10904 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10905 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10906 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10907 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10908
10909 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10910 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10911 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10912
10913 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10914 and then displayed at any time.
10915 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10916
10917 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10918 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10919 @end itemize
10920
10921 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10922 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10923 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10924 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10925 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10926 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10927 does the same thing.
10928
10929 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10930 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10931 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10932 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10933 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10934
10935 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10936 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10937 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10938 @end deffn
10939
10940 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10941 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10942 in the order they triggered.
10943 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10944 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10945 history records.
10946 @end deffn
10947
10948 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10949 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10950 they have been triggered.
10951 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10952 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10953 and associates it with that identifier.
10954
10955 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10956 are not related except by this command.
10957 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10958 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10959 @end deffn
10960
10961
10962 @node JTAG Commands
10963 @chapter JTAG Commands
10964 @cindex JTAG Commands
10965 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10966 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10967 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10968 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10969 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10970
10971 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10972 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10973
10974 @itemize @bullet
10975 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10976 devices such as a CPUs.
10977 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10978 standard state machine (in parallel)
10979 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10980 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10981 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10982 while the reading previous ones.
10983 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10984 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10985 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10986 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10987 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10988 registers.
10989 @end itemize
10990
10991 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10992
10993 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10994 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10995 the order of TAP state transitions.
10996 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10997 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10998 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10999 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
11000 these commands are not available.
11001
11002 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
11003 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
11004 that specify the entire register.
11005 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
11006 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
11007 The return value holds the original value of each
11008 of those fields.
11009
11010 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
11011 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
11012 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
11013 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
11014 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
11015
11016 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
11017 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
11018
11019 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
11020 in that state.
11021 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
11022 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
11023 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
11024
11025 @quotation Warning
11026 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
11027 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
11028 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
11029 data registers, which may have different lengths.
11030 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
11031 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
11032 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
11033 (by connecting a different scan chain).
11034 @end quotation
11035 @end deffn
11036
11037 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
11038 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
11039 This may be used for performance tuning.
11040
11041 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
11042 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
11043 not change with the amount of data which is written.
11044 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
11045 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
11046 instead of batching them into larger operations.
11047 @end deffn
11048
11049 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
11050 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
11051 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
11052 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
11053 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
11054 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
11055
11056 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
11057 in that state.
11058 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
11059 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
11060 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
11061
11062 @quotation Note
11063 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
11064 register values, unlike data register values.
11065 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
11066 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
11067 @end quotation
11068 @end deffn
11069
11070 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
11071 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
11072 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
11073 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
11074 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
11075 Then, in a series of single state transitions
11076 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
11077 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
11078 The final state must also be stable.
11079 @end deffn
11080
11081 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
11082 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
11083 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
11084 Instructions often need some time
11085 to execute before they take effect.
11086 @end deffn
11087
11088 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
11089 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
11090
11091 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
11092 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
11093 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
11094 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
11095 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
11096 @end deffn
11097
11098 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
11099 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
11100 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
11101 must also be enabled.
11102 Default is enabled.
11103 @end deffn
11104
11105 @section TAP state names
11106 @cindex TAP state names
11107
11108 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
11109 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
11110 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
11111 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
11112
11113 @itemize @bullet
11114 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
11115 acts as if TRST were pulsed
11116 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
11117 @item @b{DRSELECT}
11118 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
11119 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
11120 through the data register
11121 @item @b{DREXIT1}
11122 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
11123 for update or more shifting
11124 @item @b{DREXIT2}
11125 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
11126 @item @b{IRSELECT}
11127 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
11128 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
11129 through the instruction register
11130 @item @b{IREXIT1}
11131 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
11132 for update or more shifting
11133 @item @b{IREXIT2}
11134 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
11135 @end itemize
11136
11137 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
11138 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
11139 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
11140 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
11141
11142 @itemize @bullet
11143 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
11144 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
11145 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
11146 may not be as expected.
11147 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
11148 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
11149 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
11150 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
11151 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
11152 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
11153 @end itemize
11154
11155 @node Boundary Scan Commands
11156 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
11157
11158 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
11159 boundary scan based hardware testing.
11160 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
11161 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
11162
11163 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
11164 @cindex Serial Vector Format
11165 @cindex SVF
11166
11167 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
11168 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
11169 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
11170 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
11171
11172 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
11173 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
11174 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
11175 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
11176
11177 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
11178 affect their semantics.
11179
11180 Command options:
11181 @itemize @minus
11182 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
11183 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
11184 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
11185 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
11186 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
11187 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
11188 on the real interface;
11189 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
11190 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
11191 errors.
11192 @end itemize
11193 @end deffn
11194
11195 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
11196 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
11197 @cindex XSVF
11198
11199 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
11200 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
11201 Xilinx devices.
11202 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
11203 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
11204
11205 @quotation Important
11206 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
11207 @end quotation
11208
11209 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
11210 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
11211 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
11212 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
11213 that TAP.
11214 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
11215 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
11216 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
11217 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
11218 @end deffn
11219
11220 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
11221 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
11222 after building the software.
11223 You may find them useful:
11224
11225 @itemize
11226 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
11227 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
11228 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
11229 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
11230 @end itemize
11231
11232 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
11233 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
11234 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
11235 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
11236 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
11237 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
11238 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
11239
11240
11241 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
11242 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
11243 @cindex IPDBG
11244
11245 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
11246 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
11247 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
11248 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
11249 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
11250 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
11251
11252 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
11253 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
11254
11255 Command options:
11256 @itemize @bullet
11257 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
11258 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
11259 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
11260 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
11261 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
11262 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
11263 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
11264 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
11265 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
11266 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
11267 shift data through vir can be configured.
11268 @end itemize
11269 @end deffn
11270
11271 Examples:
11272 @example
11273 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
11274 @end example
11275 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
11276 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
11277
11278 @example
11279 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
11280 @end example
11281 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
11282 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
11283
11284 @node Utility Commands
11285 @chapter Utility Commands
11286 @cindex Utility Commands
11287
11288 @section RAM testing
11289 @cindex RAM testing
11290
11291 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
11292 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
11293 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
11294 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
11295 hardware problems.
11296
11297 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
11298 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
11299 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
11300 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
11301
11302 Load the memory testing functions with
11303
11304 @example
11305 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
11306 @end example
11307
11308 to get access to the following facilities:
11309
11310 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
11311 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
11312 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
11313 @end deffn
11314
11315 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
11316 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
11317 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
11318 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
11319 @end deffn
11320
11321 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
11322 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
11323 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
11324 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
11325 @end deffn
11326
11327 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
11328 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
11329 @end deffn
11330
11331 @section Firmware recovery helpers
11332 @cindex Firmware recovery
11333
11334 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
11335 devices recovery with JTAG.
11336
11337 For quickstart instructions run:
11338 @example
11339 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
11340 @end example
11341
11342 @node GDB and OpenOCD
11343 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
11344 @cindex GDB
11345 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
11346 to debug remote targets.
11347 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
11348
11349 @itemize
11350 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
11351 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
11352 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
11353 as shown in this chapter.
11354 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
11355 that also will probably need to be configured.
11356 @end itemize
11357
11358 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
11359 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
11360 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
11361 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
11362 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
11363 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
11364
11365 @section Connecting to GDB
11366 @cindex Connecting to GDB
11367 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
11368 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
11369 errors, which has since been fixed; see
11370 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
11371
11372 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
11373
11374 @enumerate
11375 @item
11376 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
11377 @example
11378 target extended-remote localhost:3333
11379 @end example
11380 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
11381
11382 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
11383 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
11384 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
11385
11386 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
11387 remote command above that becomes:
11388 @example
11389 tar ext :3333
11390 @end example
11391
11392 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
11393 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
11394 available through the command:
11395 @example
11396 target remote localhost:3333
11397 @end example
11398
11399 @item
11400 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
11401 @example
11402 target extended-remote | \
11403 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
11404 @end example
11405 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
11406 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
11407 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
11408 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
11409 @end enumerate
11410
11411 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
11412 GDB command line.
11413
11414 @section Sample GDB session startup
11415
11416 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
11417 than they do when you're debugging locally.
11418 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
11419 small ARM program.
11420 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
11421 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
11422
11423 @example
11424 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
11425 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
11426 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
11427 ...
11428 (gdb) monitor reset halt
11429 ...
11430 (gdb) load
11431 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
11432 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
11433 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
11434 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
11435 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
11436 (gdb) continue
11437 Continuing.
11438 ...
11439 @end example
11440
11441 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
11442 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
11443 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
11444 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
11445
11446 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
11447
11448 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
11449 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
11450 packet size and the device's memory map.
11451 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
11452 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
11453 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
11454
11455 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
11456 You may need to set those up by hand.
11457 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
11458 something like:
11459
11460 @example
11461 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
11462 @end example
11463
11464 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
11465
11466 @example
11467 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
11468 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
11469 @end example
11470
11471 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
11472 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
11473 do not have such restrictions.
11474
11475 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
11476 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
11477 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
11478 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
11479
11480 @section Programming using GDB
11481 @cindex Programming using GDB
11482 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
11483
11484 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
11485 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
11486 @example
11487 gdb_memory_map disable
11488 @end example
11489 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
11490 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
11491 working area.
11492
11493 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
11494 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
11495 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
11496 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
11497
11498 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
11499 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
11500
11501 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
11502 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
11503 @example
11504 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
11505 @end example
11506
11507 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
11508 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
11509
11510 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
11511 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
11512 will be used.
11513
11514 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
11515 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
11516 @example
11517 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
11518 @end example
11519 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
11520
11521 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
11522 can be used.
11523
11524 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11525 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11526 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
11527
11528 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
11529 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
11530 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
11531
11532 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
11533 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
11534 and GDB treats it as it were running.
11535 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
11536 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
11537 without any intrusion of the target process.
11538
11539 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
11540 Place following command after target configuration:
11541 @example
11542 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
11543 @end example
11544
11545 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
11546 switch off gdb_memory_map:
11547 @example
11548 gdb_memory_map disable
11549 @end example
11550
11551 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
11552 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
11553 @example
11554 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
11555 @end example
11556
11557 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
11558 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
11559
11560 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
11561 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
11562 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
11563 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
11564
11565 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
11566 previously shown variables.
11567
11568 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
11569 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
11570 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
11571 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
11572 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
11573
11574 @section RTOS Support
11575 @cindex RTOS Support
11576 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
11577
11578 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
11579 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
11580
11581 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
11582 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
11583 GDB commands.
11584
11585 @* An example setup is below:
11586
11587 @example
11588 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
11589 @end example
11590
11591 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11592
11593 Currently supported rtos's include:
11594 @itemize @bullet
11595 @item @option{eCos}
11596 @item @option{ThreadX}
11597 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11598 @item @option{linux}
11599 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11600 @item @option{embKernel}
11601 @item @option{mqx}
11602 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11603 @item @option{nuttx}
11604 @item @option{RIOT}
11605 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11606 @item @option{Zephyr}
11607 @end itemize
11608
11609 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11610 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11611
11612 @table @code
11613 @item eCos symbols
11614 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11615 @item ThreadX symbols
11616 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11617 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11618 @raggedright
11619 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11620 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11621 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11622 @end raggedright
11623 @item linux symbols
11624 init_task.
11625 @item ChibiOS symbols
11626 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11627 @item embKernel symbols
11628 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11629 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11630 @item mqx symbols
11631 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11632 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11633 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11634 @item nuttx symbols
11635 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11636 @item RIOT symbols
11637 @raggedright
11638 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11639 _tcb_name_offset.
11640 @end raggedright
11641 @item Zephyr symbols
11642 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
11643 @end table
11644
11645 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11646 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
11647
11648 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
11649 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
11650
11651 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11652 along with the project:
11653
11654 @table @code
11655 @item FreeRTOS
11656 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11657 @item uC/OS-III
11658 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11659 @end table
11660
11661 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11662 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11663 @cindex SMP
11664 @cindex RTOS
11665 @cindex hwthread
11666 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11667 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11668 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11669 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11670 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11671 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11672 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11673 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11674 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11675
11676 @node Tcl Scripting API
11677 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11678 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11679 @cindex Tcl scripts
11680 @section API rules
11681
11682 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11683 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11684 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11685
11686 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11687 pair list and lists.
11688
11689 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11690 list.
11691
11692 @example
11693 > set foo(me) Duane
11694 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11695 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11696 > set foo(duck) Donald
11697 @end example
11698
11699 If one does this:
11700
11701 @example
11702 > set foo
11703 @end example
11704
11705 The result is:
11706
11707 @example
11708 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11709 @end example
11710
11711 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11712
11713 @verbatim
11714 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11715 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11716 }
11717 @end verbatim
11718
11719 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11720 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11721
11722 @section Internal low-level Commands
11723
11724 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
11725 invoke directly.
11726
11727 @itemize
11728 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11729
11730 Return information about the flash banks
11731
11732 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11733
11734 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11735 its execution. Example:
11736
11737 @example
11738 > capture "reset init"
11739 @end example
11740
11741 @end itemize
11742
11743 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11744 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11745 called "flash_banks".
11746
11747 @section Tcl RPC server
11748 @cindex RPC
11749
11750 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11751 commands and receive the results.
11752
11753 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11754 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11755 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11756 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11757 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11758
11759 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11760 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11761 @command{capture} command.
11762
11763 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11764
11765 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11766 @cindex RPC Notifications
11767
11768 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11769 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11770
11771 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11772 in the following format.
11773
11774 @verbatim
11775 type target_event event [event-name]
11776 type target_state state [state-name]
11777 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11778 @end verbatim
11779
11780 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11781 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11782 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11783 Defaults to off.
11784
11785 @end deffn
11786
11787 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11788 @cindex RPC trace output
11789
11790 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11791 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11792
11793 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11794
11795 @verbatim
11796 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11797 @end verbatim
11798
11799 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11800 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11801 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11802 Defaults to off.
11803
11804 See an example application here:
11805 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11806
11807 @end deffn
11808
11809 @node FAQ
11810 @chapter FAQ
11811 @cindex faq
11812 @enumerate
11813 @anchor{faqrtck}
11814 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11815 @cindex RTCK
11816 @cindex adaptive clocking
11817 @*
11818
11819 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11820 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11821 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11822 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11823
11824 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11825 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11826 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11827 @enumerate
11828 @item
11829 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11830 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11831 @item
11832 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11833 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11834 @end enumerate
11835
11836 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11837 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11838 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11839 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11840 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11841 power).
11842
11843 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11844 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11845 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11846 ARM926 scenario).
11847 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11848 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11849 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11850
11851 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11852 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11853 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11854 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11855
11856 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11857
11858 In order to make use of this,
11859 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11860 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11861
11862 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11863 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11864 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11865 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11866 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11867
11868 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11869 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11870 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11871 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11872
11873 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11874 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11875 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11876 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11877 with a CPLD.
11878 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11879 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11880 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11881 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11882 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11883 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11884
11885 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11886
11887 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11888
11889 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11890 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11891 depending on the chips on your board.
11892 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11893 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11894 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11895
11896 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11897 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11898 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11899
11900 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11901 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11902 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11903 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11904
11905 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11906 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11907 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11908 this way.
11909
11910 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11911 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11912 clock rate.
11913 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11914 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11915 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11916
11917 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11918
11919 @example
11920 # Example: 1.234MHz
11921 adapter speed 1234
11922 @end example
11923
11924
11925 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11926
11927 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11928 around Windows filenames.
11929
11930 @example
11931 > echo \a
11932
11933 > echo @{\a@}
11934 \a
11935 > echo "\a"
11936
11937 >
11938 @end example
11939
11940
11941 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11942
11943 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11944 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11945 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11946
11947 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11948 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11949 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11950
11951 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11952 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11953 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11954
11955 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11956
11957 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11958 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11959 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11960 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11961
11962 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11963 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11964 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11965
11966 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11967 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11968
11969 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11970 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11971 memory read caused data abort".
11972
11973 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11974 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11975 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11976 be done, feel free to add this here.
11977
11978 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11979 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11980 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11981 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11982 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11983 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11984 gracefully stops.
11985
11986 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11987 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11988 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11989
11990 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11991 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
11992 bytes. Painful...
11993
11994
11995 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11996 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11997
11998 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11999 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
12000 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
12001 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
12002 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
12003 reset, everything else should work fine.
12004
12005 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
12006 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
12007 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
12008 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
12009
12010 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
12011 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
12012 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
12013 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
12014
12015 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
12016
12017 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
12018 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
12019 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
12020
12021 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
12022 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
12023
12024 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
12025 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
12026 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
12027 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
12028 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
12029 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
12030 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
12031 clock frequency?
12032
12033 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
12034 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
12035 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
12036 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
12037 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
12038
12039 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
12040
12041 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
12042 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
12043 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
12044 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
12045 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
12046 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
12047 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
12048
12049 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
12050
12051 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
12052 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
12053 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
12054 up DRAM and loading it with code.
12055
12056 @anchor{faqtaporder}
12057 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
12058 particular order?
12059
12060 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
12061 the same order used by the hardware.
12062
12063 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
12064 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
12065 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
12066 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
12067 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
12068 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
12069
12070 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
12071 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
12072 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
12073 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
12074
12075 @itemize @bullet
12076 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
12077 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
12078 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
12079 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
12080 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
12081 @end itemize
12082
12083 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
12084
12085 @itemize @bullet
12086 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
12087 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
12088 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
12089 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
12090 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
12091 @end itemize
12092
12093
12094 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
12095 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
12096 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
12097
12098 TODO.
12099
12100 @end enumerate
12101
12102 @node Tcl Crash Course
12103 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
12104 @cindex Tcl
12105
12106 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
12107 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
12108 how the Tcl scripts work.
12109
12110 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
12111 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
12112 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
12113 OpenOCD.
12114
12115 @section Tcl Rule #1
12116 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
12117 @enumerate
12118 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
12119 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12120 @end enumerate
12121
12122 The Tcl equal is this:
12123
12124 @enumerate
12125 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
12126 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12127 @end enumerate
12128
12129 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
12130 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
12131
12132 @section Tcl Rule #1b
12133 There is a second pair of rules.
12134 @enumerate
12135 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
12136 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
12137 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
12138 in Tcl.
12139 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12140 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
12141 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
12142 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
12143 @end enumerate
12144
12145 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
12146 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
12147 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
12148 Everything is a string}
12149
12150 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
12151 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
12152 difference is subtle.
12153 @enumerate
12154 @item Parse Time
12155 @item Evaluation Time
12156 @end enumerate
12157
12158 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
12159 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
12160 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
12161
12162 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
12163 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
12164 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
12165 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
12166
12167 @itemize @bullet
12168 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
12169 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
12170 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
12171 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
12172 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
12173 @example
12174 # bash example
12175 X=`date`
12176 echo "The Date is: $X"
12177 # Tcl example
12178 set X [date]
12179 puts "The Date is: $X"
12180 @end example
12181 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
12182 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
12183 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
12184 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
12185 is a string}
12186 @example
12187 set x "Dinner"
12188 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
12189 @end example
12190 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
12191 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
12192 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
12193 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
12194 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
12195 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
12196 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
12197 @end itemize
12198
12199 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
12200
12201 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
12202
12203 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
12204
12205 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
12206 the normal way.
12207
12208 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
12209 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
12210 line is immediately executed.
12211
12212 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
12213 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
12214
12215 @subsection Command Execution
12216
12217 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
12218 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
12219 control flow operators.
12220
12221 Commands are executed like this:
12222
12223 @enumerate
12224 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
12225 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
12226 @item Repeat until End Of File.
12227 @end enumerate
12228
12229 It sort of works like this:
12230 @example
12231 for(;;)@{
12232 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
12233
12234 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
12235
12236 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
12237 @}
12238 @end example
12239
12240 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
12241 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
12242 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
12243 of the function. Note the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
12244 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
12245 ``LookupCommand()''
12246
12247 @subsection The FOR command
12248
12249 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
12250 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
12251 command just like any other command.
12252
12253 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
12254 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
12255 are:
12256
12257 @enumerate 0
12258 @item The ascii text 'for'
12259 @item The start text
12260 @item The test expression
12261 @item The next text
12262 @item The body text
12263 @end enumerate
12264
12265 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
12266 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
12267 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
12268 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
12269
12270 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
12271 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
12272
12273 @example
12274 int
12275 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
12276 int *argc,
12277 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
12278 @end example
12279
12280 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
12281 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
12282 still operates in the same basic way.
12283
12284 @subsection FOR command implementation
12285
12286 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
12287 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
12288
12289 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
12290
12291 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
12292
12293 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
12294 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
12295 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
12296
12297 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
12298 expression and returns a value.
12299
12300 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
12301 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
12302 @example
12303 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
12304
12305 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
12306
12307 int
12308 MyForCommand( void *interp,
12309 int argc,
12310 char **argv )
12311 @{
12312 if( argc != 5 )@{
12313 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
12314 return ERROR;
12315 @}
12316
12317 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
12318
12319 // Execute the start statement.
12320 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
12321
12322 // Top of loop test
12323 for(;;)@{
12324 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
12325 if( i == 0 )
12326 break;
12327
12328 // Execute the body
12329 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
12330
12331 // Execute the LOOP part
12332 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
12333 @}
12334
12335 // Return no error
12336 SetResult( interp, "" );
12337 return SUCCESS;
12338 @}
12339 @end example
12340
12341 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
12342 in the same basic way.
12343
12344 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
12345
12346 @subsection source and find commands
12347 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
12348 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
12349 @*Remember the parsing rules
12350 @enumerate
12351 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
12352 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
12353 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
12354 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
12355 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
12356 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
12357 That character begins Tcl comments.)
12358 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
12359 it reads a file and executes as a script.
12360 @end enumerate
12361 @subsection format command
12362 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
12363 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
12364 @b{sprintf()}.
12365 @b{Example}
12366 @example
12367 set x 6
12368 set y 7
12369 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr @{$x * $y@}]]
12370 @end example
12371 @enumerate
12372 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
12373 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
12374 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
12375 @* Refer to Rule #1
12376 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
12377 @* Refer to Rule #1.
12378 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
12379 @end enumerate
12380 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
12381 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
12382 @example
12383 #1 Good
12384 proc someproc @{@} @{
12385 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
12386 @}
12387 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
12388 #2 Good - no variables
12389 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
12390 #3 Good Curly Braces
12391 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
12392 puts "Time: [date]"
12393 @}
12394 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
12395 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
12396 @end example
12397 @enumerate
12398 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
12399 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
12400 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
12401 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
12402 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
12403 command.
12404 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
12405 @*There are 4 examples:
12406 @enumerate
12407 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
12408 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
12409 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
12410 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
12411 @end enumerate
12412
12413 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
12414 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
12415 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
12416
12417 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
12418 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
12419 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
12420 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
12421 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
12422 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
12423 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
12424 @end enumerate
12425 @subsection Global Variables
12426 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
12427 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
12428 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
12429 @example
12430 proc myproc @{ @} @{
12431 set y 0 #Local variable Y
12432 global x #Global variable X
12433 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
12434 @}
12435 @end example
12436 @section Other Tcl Hacks
12437 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
12438 @example
12439 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
12440 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr @{$x + 1@}]@} @{
12441 # Create var name
12442 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
12443 # Make it a global
12444 global $vn
12445 # Set it.
12446 set $vn [expr @{1 << $x@}]
12447 @}
12448 @end example
12449 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
12450 @example
12451 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
12452 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
12453 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
12454 @}
12455 @end example
12456
12457 @node License
12458 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
12459 @include fdl.texi
12460
12461 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
12462 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
12463 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
12464 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
12465 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
12466 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
12467
12468 @printindex cp
12469
12470 @node Command and Driver Index
12471 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
12472 @printindex fn
12473
12474 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)